flash/nor: add support of STM32WB on top STM32L4 flash driver
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
160 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
491 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
492 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
493 @end itemize
494
495 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
496 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
497 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
498 @itemize @bullet
499 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
500 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
501 @end itemize
502
503 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
504 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
505 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
506 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
507
508 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
509 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
510 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
511
512 @section USB Other
513 @itemize @bullet
514 @item @b{USBprog}
515 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
516
517 @item @b{USB - Presto}
518 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
519
520 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
522
523 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
524 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
525
526 @item @b{Buspirate}
527 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
528
529 @item @b{opendous}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
531
532 @item @b{estick}
533 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
534
535 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
536 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
537
538 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
539 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
540 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
541 @* The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB debug probe. The XDS110
542 stand-alone probe has the additional ability to supply voltage to the target
543 board via its AUX FUNCTIONS port. Use the
544 @command{xds110_supply_voltage <millivolts>} command to set the voltage. 0 turns
545 off the supply. Otherwise, the supply can be set to any value in the range 1800
546 to 3600 millivolts.
547 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
548 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
549 @end itemize
550
551 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
552
553 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
554 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
555 these on the market.
556
557 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
558 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
559 of USB-based ones.
560
561 @itemize @bullet
562
563 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
564 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
565
566 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
567 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
568 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
569
570 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler2}
574 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
575
576 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
577 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
578
579 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
580 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
581
582 @item @b{arm-jtag}
583 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
584
585 @item @b{chameleon}
586 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
587
588 @item @b{Triton}
589 @* Unknown.
590
591 @item @b{Lattice}
592 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
593 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
594
595 @item @b{flashlink}
596 @* From STMicroelectronics;
597 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
598
599 @end itemize
600
601 @section Other...
602 @itemize @bullet
603
604 @item @b{ep93xx}
605 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
606
607 @item @b{at91rm9200}
608 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
609
610 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
611 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
612
613 @item @b{imx_gpio}
614 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
615
616 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
617 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
618 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
619
620 @end itemize
621
622 @node About Jim-Tcl
623 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
624 @cindex Jim-Tcl
625 @cindex tcl
626
627 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
628 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
629 command interpreter.
630
631 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
632 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
633 much of anything about Tcl.
634 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
635
636 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
637 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
638 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
639 OpenOCD mailing list.
640
641 @itemize @bullet
642 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
643 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
644 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
645 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
646 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
647 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
648
649 @item @b{Missing Features}
650 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
651 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
652 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
653 enabled in OpenOCD.
654
655 @item @b{Scripts}
656 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
657 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
658 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
659
660 @item @b{Commands}
661 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
662 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
663 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
664 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
665
666 @item @b{Historical Note}
667 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
668 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
669 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
670 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
671
672 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
673 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
674 @end itemize
675
676 @node Running
677 @chapter Running
678 @cindex command line options
679 @cindex logfile
680 @cindex directory search
681
682 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
683 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
684 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
685 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
686 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
687 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
688 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
689
690 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
691 tell it how each debug session should work.
692 The @option{--help} option shows:
693 @verbatim
694 bash$ openocd --help
695
696 --help | -h display this help
697 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
698 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
699 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
700 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
701 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
702 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
703 --command | -c run <command>
704 @end verbatim
705
706 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
707 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
708 To specify one or more different
709 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
710
711 @example
712 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
713 @end example
714
715 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
716 @enumerate
717 @item the current directory,
718 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
719 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
720 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
721 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
722 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
723 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
724 @end enumerate
725 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
726
727 @quotation Note
728 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
729 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
730 @end quotation
731
732 @section Simple setup, no customization
733
734 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
735 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
736 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
737 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
738 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
739
740 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
741 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
742 the server with some variation of one of the following:
743
744 @example
745 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
746 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
747 @end example
748
749 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
750 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
751 If all goes well you'll see output something like
752
753 @example
754 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
755 For bug reports, read
756 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
757 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
758 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
759 @end example
760
761 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
762 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
763 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
764
765 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
766
767 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
768 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
769 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
770 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
771 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
772 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
773 ensure that this always succeeds.
774 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
775 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
776 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
777 and then shut down without acting as a server.
778
779 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
780 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
781 those channels.
782
783 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
784 the @option{-d} option.
785
786 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
787 @option{-c} command line switch.
788
789 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
790 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
791 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
792 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
793 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
794 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
795 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
796
797 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
798 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
799
800 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
801 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
802 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
803 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
804
805 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
806 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
807
808 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
809 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
810 and start the OpenOCD server.
811 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
812 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
813 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
814 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
815
816 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
817
818 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
819 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
820 and a USB cable on the other.
821 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
822 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
823
824 @enumerate
825 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
826 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
827 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
828 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
829 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
830 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
831 debugging host.
832
833 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
834 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
835 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
836 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
837 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
838
839 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
840 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
841 with 1.2 Volt boards.
842
843 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
844 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
845 ways to connect the cable.
846 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
847 Be sure it's firmly connected.
848
849 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
850 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
851 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
852 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
853 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
854 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
855 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
856 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
857
858 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
859 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
860 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
861 but are tedious to set up.
862 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
863 adapter signals to the right board pins.
864
865 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
866 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
867 you are using to run OpenOCD.
868 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
869
870 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
871 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
872 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
873 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
874
875 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
876 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
877 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
878
879 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
880 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
881 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
882 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
883
884 @end enumerate
885
886 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
887 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
888 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
889
890 @section Project Directory
891
892 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
893
894 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
895 single directory for your work with a given board.
896 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
897 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
898 files accessed through semihosting,
899 and for code you upload to the target board.
900 It is also the natural place to write files,
901 such as log files and data you download from the board.
902
903 @section Configuration Basics
904
905 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
906 a variety of ways you can mix them.
907 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
908
909 @itemize
910 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
911 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
912 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
913 @end itemize
914
915 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
916 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
917 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
918
919 @example
920 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
921
922 # GDB can also flash my flash!
923 gdb_memory_map enable
924 gdb_flash_program enable
925
926 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
927 @end example
928
929 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
930
931 @example
932 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
933 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
934 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
935 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
936 @end example
937
938 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
939 each supporting a different development task.
940 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
941 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
942
943 @quotation Important
944 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
945 problems with how it treats variables.
946 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
947 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
948 that can be tested in a later script.
949 @end quotation
950
951 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
952 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
953 to simplify your work.
954
955 @section User Config Files
956 @cindex config file, user
957 @cindex user config file
958 @cindex config file, overview
959
960 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
961 in one place.
962 One of the following will match your situation best:
963
964 @itemize
965 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
966 provided by someone else.
967 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
968 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
969 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
970 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
971 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
972 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
973
974 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
975 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
976
977 @enumerate
978 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
979 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
980 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
981 @end enumerate
982
983 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
984 The first is an interface config file.
985 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
986 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
987 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
988 meet your deadline:
989
990 @example
991 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
992 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
993 @end example
994
995 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
996 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
997 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
998 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
999
1000 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1001 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1002 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1003 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1004 target and board
1005 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1006 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1007
1008 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1009 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1010 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1011 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1012
1013 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1014 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1015 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1016 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1017 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1018
1019 @quotation Note
1020 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1021 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1022 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1023 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1024 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1025 @end quotation
1026
1027 @item
1028 You may may need to write some C code.
1029 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1030 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1031 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1032 a new chip architecture.
1033 @end itemize
1034
1035 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1036 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1037 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1038
1039 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1040 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1041 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1042 @itemize
1043
1044 @item
1045 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1046 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1047 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1048 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1049
1050 @item
1051 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1052 @cindex vector_catch
1053 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1054 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1055 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1056 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1057 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1058 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1059
1060 @item
1061 You might need to override some defaults.
1062 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1063 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1064
1065 @item
1066 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1067 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1068 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1069 @end itemize
1070
1071 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1072
1073 A few project-specific utility
1074 routines may well speed up your work.
1075 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1076
1077 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1078 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1079 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1080 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1081 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1082 may help:
1083
1084 @example
1085 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1086 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1087 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1088 # Leave the CPU halted.
1089 reset init
1090
1091 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1092 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1093
1094 # Start running.
1095 resume 0x20000000
1096 @}
1097 @end example
1098
1099 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1100 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1101 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1102 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1103 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1104
1105 @example
1106 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1107 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1108 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1109 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1110 reset init
1111
1112 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1113 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1114 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1115 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1116 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1117 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1118 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1119
1120 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1121 reset run
1122 @}
1123 @end example
1124
1125 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1126 from NAND.
1127 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1128 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1129 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1130
1131 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1132 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1133
1134 @section Target Software Changes
1135
1136 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1137 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1138 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1139 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1140 handling issues like:
1141
1142 @itemize @bullet
1143
1144 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1145 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1146 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1147 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1148 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1149 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1150 your debug sessions.
1151
1152 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1153 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1154 That might however be your only option.
1155
1156 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1157 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1158 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1159 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1160 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1161 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1162 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1163 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1164 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1165 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1166 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1167 instead of the whole thing.
1168 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1169 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1170
1171 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1172 @cindex ARM semihosting
1173 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1174 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1175 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1176 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1177 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1178 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1179 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1180 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1181 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1182 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1183 NAND or SPI flash.
1184
1185 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1186 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1187 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1188 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1189 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1190
1191 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1192 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1193 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1194 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1195 registers which can be used to change various features including
1196 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1197 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1198 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1199 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1200 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1201
1202 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1203 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1204 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1205 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1206 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1207
1208 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1209 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1210 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1211 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1212 early code execution can be debugged
1213 or firmware can be replaced.
1214
1215 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1216 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1217 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1218 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1219 operations like writing to memory.)
1220
1221 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1222 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1223 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1224 various kinds of message.
1225 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1226
1227 @end itemize
1228
1229 @section Target Hardware Setup
1230
1231 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1232 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1233 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1234 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1235 working with.}
1236
1237 Common issues include:
1238
1239 @itemize @bullet
1240
1241 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1242 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1243 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1244 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1245 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1246 or one from a daughtercard).
1247 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1248 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1249
1250 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1251 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1252 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1253 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1254 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1255 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1256
1257 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1258 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1259 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1260 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1261 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1262
1263
1264 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1265 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1266 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1267 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1268 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1269 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1270 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1271
1272 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1273 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1274 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1275 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1276 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1277
1278 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1279 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1280 used to start booting.
1281
1282 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1283 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1284 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1285 multiple audio codec chips).
1286 This interacts with software
1287 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1288 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1289 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1290 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1291 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1292 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1293 audio or video codecs are used.
1294
1295 @end itemize
1296
1297 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1298 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1299 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1300 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1301 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1302 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1303 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1304 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1305 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1306 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1307
1308
1309 @node Config File Guidelines
1310 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1311
1312 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1313 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1314 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1315 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1316
1317 You should find the following directories under
1318 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1319 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1320 @itemize @bullet
1321 @item @file{interface} ...
1322 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1323 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1324 @item @file{board} ...
1325 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1326 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1327
1328 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1329 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1330 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1331 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1332 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1333 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1334 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1335 a CPU and an FPGA.
1336 @item @file{target} ...
1337 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1338 on a chip
1339 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1340 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1341 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1342 the target config file defines all of them.
1343 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1344 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1345 @end itemize
1346
1347 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1348 file may override features in any of the above files by
1349 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1350 commands specific to their situation.
1351
1352 @section Interface Config Files
1353
1354 The user config file
1355 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1356
1357 @example
1358 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1359 @end example
1360
1361 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1362 in use today with OpenOCD.
1363 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1364 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1365
1366 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1367 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1368 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1369 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1370 and need to provide a driver for it.
1371
1372 @section Board Config Files
1373 @cindex config file, board
1374 @cindex board config file
1375
1376 The user config file
1377 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1378
1379 @example
1380 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1381 @end example
1382
1383 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1384 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1385 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1386
1387 @enumerate
1388 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1389 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1390 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1391 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1392 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1393 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1394 @end enumerate
1395
1396 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1397 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1398 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1399 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1400
1401 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1402 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1403 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1404 configuration works.
1405
1406 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1407
1408 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1409 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1410 convention on how to use certain variables.
1411
1412 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1413 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1414 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1415 used at will within a target configuration file.
1416
1417 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1418 for a board with three chips:
1419
1420 @example
1421 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1422 set CHIPNAME network
1423 set ENDIAN big
1424 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1425 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1426 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1427 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1428
1429 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1430 set CHIPNAME video
1431 set ENDIAN little
1432 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1433 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1434 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1435 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1436
1437 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1438 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1439 unset ENDIAN
1440 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1441 @end example
1442
1443 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1444 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1445 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1446 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1447 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1448 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1449 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1450 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1451
1452 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1453 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1454 naming collisions.
1455
1456 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1457 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1458 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1459 up other clocks and peripherals.
1460
1461 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1462 @cindex variable names
1463
1464 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1465 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1466 one such chip (as shown above).
1467 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1468 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1469 to promote consistency and
1470 so that board files can override target defaults.
1471
1472 Inputs to target config files include:
1473
1474 @itemize @bullet
1475 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1476 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1477 tap identifier dotted names.
1478 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1479 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1480 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1481 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1482 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1483 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1484 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1485 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1486 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1487 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1488 @end itemize
1489
1490 Outputs from target config files include:
1491
1492 @itemize @bullet
1493 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1494 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1495 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1496 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1497 specific to that board and that target.
1498 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1499 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1500 @end itemize
1501
1502 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1503 @cindex event, reset-init
1504 @cindex reset-init handler
1505
1506 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1507 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1508 fully set up yet.
1509 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1510 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1511 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1512 handler is one of the most important.
1513
1514 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1515 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1516 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1517 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1518 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1519
1520 @quotation Note
1521 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1522 are included here.
1523 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1524 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1525 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1526 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1527 @end quotation
1528
1529 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1530 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1531 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1532 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1533 those as parameters.
1534 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1535 and disabling the watchdog.
1536 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1537 the next developer doing such work.
1538 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1539
1540 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1541 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1542 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1543 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1544
1545 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1546
1547 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1548 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1549 a low JTAG clock rate.
1550 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1551 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1552 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1553 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1554 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1555 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1556 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1557
1558 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1559 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1560 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1561 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1562 which might be less than that.
1563
1564 @quotation Warning
1565 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1566 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1567 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1568 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1569 @end quotation
1570
1571 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1572 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1573 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1574 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1575 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1576 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1577
1578 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1579 @subsection The init_board procedure
1580 @cindex init_board procedure
1581
1582 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1583 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1584 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1585 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1586 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1587 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1588 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1589 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1590 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1591 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1592 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1593 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1594
1595 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1596 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1597
1598 @example
1599 ### board_file.cfg ###
1600
1601 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1602 source [find target/target.cfg]
1603
1604 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1605 # enables fast on-board clock source
1606 # configures the chip to use it
1607 @}
1608
1609 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1610 proc init_board @{@} @{
1611 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1612
1613 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1614 adapter_khz 100
1615 @}
1616
1617 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1618 enable_fast_clock
1619 adapter_khz 10000
1620 @}
1621 @}
1622 @end example
1623
1624 @section Target Config Files
1625 @cindex config file, target
1626 @cindex target config file
1627
1628 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1629 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1630 more target config files like this:
1631
1632 @example
1633 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1634 @end example
1635
1636 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1637 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1638 In summary the target files should contain
1639
1640 @enumerate
1641 @item Set defaults
1642 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1643 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1644 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1645 @item On-Chip flash
1646 @end enumerate
1647
1648 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1649 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1650 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1651
1652 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1653 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1654 can talk to the chip.
1655 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1656 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1657 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1658 and other processing engines.
1659
1660 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1661
1662 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1663 letting board config files express environment-specific
1664 differences in how things should be set up.
1665
1666 @example
1667 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1668 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1669 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1670 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1671 @} else @{
1672 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1673 @}
1674
1675 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1676 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1677 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _ENDIAN little
1680 @}
1681
1682 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1683 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1684 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1685 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1686 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1689 @}
1690 @end example
1691 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1692
1693 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1694 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1695 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1696
1697 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1698 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1699 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1700
1701 @example
1702 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1703 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1704 @end example
1705
1706 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1707 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1708 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1709 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1710 for taps.
1711
1712 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1713 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1714 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1715 looks (in part) like this:
1716
1717 @example
1718 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1719 @end example
1720
1721 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1722 to source such a config file twice, with different
1723 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1724 it adds a different TAP each time.
1725
1726 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1727 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1728 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1729 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1730
1731 @example
1732 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1733 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1734 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1735 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1736 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1737 @end example
1738
1739 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1740 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1741
1742 @itemize
1743 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1744 plus a JRC to enable them
1745 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1746 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1747 is not currently used)
1748 @end itemize
1749
1750 @subsection Add CPU targets
1751
1752 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1753 GDB and other commands can use it.
1754 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1755 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1756 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1757 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1758
1759 @example
1760 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1761 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1762 @end example
1763
1764 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1765 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1766 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1767 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1768 a work area if you can.
1769 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1770
1771 @example
1772 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1773 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1774 @end example
1775
1776 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1777 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1778 @cindex SMP
1779 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1780
1781 @example
1782 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1783 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1784 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1785 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1786 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1787 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1788 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1789 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1790 @end example
1791 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1792 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1793 @itemize @bullet
1794 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1795 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1796 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1797 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1798 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1799 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1800 @end itemize
1801
1802 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1803 command have been implemented.
1804 @itemize @bullet
1805 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1806 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1807 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1808 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1809 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1810 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1811 following example.
1812 @end itemize
1813
1814 @example
1815 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1816 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1817 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1818 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1819 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1820 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1821 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1822 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1823 > resume
1824 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1825 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1826 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1827 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1828 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1829 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1830 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1831 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1832 @end example
1833
1834
1835 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1836
1837 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1838 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1839 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1840
1841 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1842 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1843 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1844 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1845 both signals.
1846
1847 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1848 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1849 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1850 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1851 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1852 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1853 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1854 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1855 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1856 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1857 not available.)
1858
1859 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1860 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1861 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1862 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1863 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1864 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1865 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1866 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1867
1868 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1869 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1870 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1871 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1872 slower clock than they will use later.
1873 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1874 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1875 than they will use later.
1876 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1877
1878 @quotation Important
1879 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1880 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1881 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1882 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1883 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1884 @end quotation
1885
1886 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1887 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1888 @cindex init_targets procedure
1889
1890 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1891 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1892 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1893 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1894 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1895 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1896 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1897 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1898 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1899
1900 @example
1901 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1902
1903 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1904 # basic initialization procedure ...
1905 @}
1906
1907 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1908 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1909 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1910 @}
1911
1912 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1913
1914 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1915
1916 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1917 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1918 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1919 @}
1920 @end example
1921
1922 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1923 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1924
1925 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1926
1927 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1928 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1929
1930 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1931 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1932 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1933
1934 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1935 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1936 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1937 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1938 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1939 events already assigned.
1940
1941 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1942
1943 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1944 special high speed download features - enable it.
1945
1946 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1947
1948 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1949 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1950 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1951 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1952 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1953 If you are using an external trace port,
1954 configure it in your board config file.
1955 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1956 configure it in your target config file.
1957
1958 @example
1959 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1960 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1964
1965 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1966
1967 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1968 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1969 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1970 the TARGET (chip) file.
1971
1972 Examples:
1973 @itemize @bullet
1974 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1975 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1976 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1977 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1978 @end itemize
1979
1980 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1981 @section Translating Configuration Files
1982 @cindex translation
1983 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1984 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1985 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1986 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1987 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1988 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1989
1990 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1991 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1992 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1993 convert other scripts later on.
1994
1995 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1996 replace job:
1997
1998 @example
1999 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2000 #
2001 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2002 #
2003 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2004 #
2005 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2006
2007 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2008 global TARGETNAME
2009
2010 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2011
2012 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2013 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2014 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2015 @}
2016 @end example
2017
2018
2019
2020 @node Server Configuration
2021 @chapter Server Configuration
2022 @cindex initialization
2023 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2024 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2025 supported.
2026
2027 @anchor{configurationstage}
2028 @section Configuration Stage
2029 @cindex configuration stage
2030 @cindex config command
2031
2032 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2033 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2034 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2035 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2036 inside startup scripts.
2037
2038 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2039 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2040 which may be issued interactively.
2041 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2042 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2043
2044 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2045 flash banks,
2046 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2047 and other basic setup.
2048 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2049 may access or activate TAPs.
2050 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2051 longer be issued.
2052
2053 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2054 @section Entering the Run Stage
2055
2056 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2057 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2058 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2059 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2060 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2061 You should see no errors at this point.
2062 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2063 commands you used to configure the server.
2064 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2065 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2066 on the scan chain.
2067
2068 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2069 become available.
2070 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2071 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2072 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2073 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2074 entry to the run stage.
2075
2076 @deffn {Config Command} init
2077 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2078 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2079 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2080 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2081 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2082 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2083
2084 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2085 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2086 configuration files and/or command line options.
2087
2088 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2089 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2090 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2091 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2092 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2093 @end deffn
2094
2095 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2096 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2097 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2098
2099 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2100 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2101 scan chain.
2102 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2103 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2104
2105 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2106 they return.
2107 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2108 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @anchor{tcpipports}
2112 @section TCP/IP Ports
2113 @cindex TCP port
2114 @cindex server
2115 @cindex port
2116 @cindex security
2117 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2118 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2119 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2120
2121 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2122 access using one or more of these ports.
2123 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2124 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2125 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2126
2127 @anchor{gdb_port}
2128 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2129 @cindex GDB server
2130 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2131 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2132 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2133 the normal use cases.
2134
2135 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2136 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2137 disables the gdb server.
2138
2139 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2140 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2141
2142 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2143 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2144
2145 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2146 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2147 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2148
2149 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2150 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2151 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2152 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2153 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2154 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2155 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2156 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2157 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2158
2159 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2160 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2161 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2162 @end deffn
2163
2164 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2165 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2166 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2167 output from the Tcl engine.
2168 Intended as a machine interface.
2169 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2170 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2171 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2172 @end deffn
2173
2174 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2175 Specify or query the
2176 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2177 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2178 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2179 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2180 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2181 @end deffn
2182
2183 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2184 @section GDB Configuration
2185 @cindex GDB
2186 @cindex GDB configuration
2187 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2188 The ones listed here are static and global.
2189 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2190 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2191
2192 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2193 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2194 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2195 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2196 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2197 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2198 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2199 @end deffn
2200
2201 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2202 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2203 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2204 vFlash packet is received.
2205 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2206 @end deffn
2207
2208 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2209 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2210 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2211 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2212 for flash programming to work.
2213 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2214 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2215 @end deffn
2216
2217 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2218 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2219 by GDB memory read packets.
2220 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2221 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2222 @end deffn
2223
2224 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2225 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2226 packets report errors or not.
2227 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2228 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2229 @end deffn
2230
2231 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2232 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2234 @end deffn
2235
2236 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2237 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2238
2239 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2240 @end deffn
2241
2242 @anchor{eventpolling}
2243 @section Event Polling
2244
2245 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2246 where significant events can happen at any time.
2247 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2248 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2249 or to GDB.
2250
2251 Examples of such events include:
2252
2253 @itemize
2254 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2255 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2256 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2257 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2258 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2259 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2260 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2261 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2262 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2263 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2264 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2265 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2266 @end itemize
2267
2268 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2269 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2270 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2271 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2272 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2273
2274 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2275 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2276 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2277 to the various active targets.
2278 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2279 which is normally done in the background.
2280
2281 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2282 Poll the current target for its current state.
2283 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2284 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2285 specific information about the current state is printed.
2286 An optional parameter
2287 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2288
2289 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2290 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2291 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2292 @example
2293 > poll
2294 background polling: on
2295 target state: halted
2296 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2297 current mode: Supervisor
2298 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2299 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2300 >
2301 @end example
2302 @end deffn
2303
2304 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2305 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2306 @cindex config file, interface
2307 @cindex interface config file
2308
2309 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2310 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2311 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2312
2313 @quotation Note
2314 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2315 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2316 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2317 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2318 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2319 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2320 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2321 @end quotation
2322
2323 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2324 through commands in an interface configuration
2325 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2326 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2327
2328 @example
2329 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2330 @end example
2331
2332 These commands tell
2333 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2334 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2335
2336 @example
2337 # jlink interface
2338 interface jlink
2339 @end example
2340
2341 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2342
2343
2344 @section Interface Configuration
2345
2346 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2347 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2348 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2349
2350 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2351 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2352 target.
2353 @end deffn
2354
2355 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2356 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2357 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2358 @end deffn
2359 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2360 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2361 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2362 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2363 the hardware can support.
2364 @end deffn
2365
2366
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2369 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2370 @end deffn
2371
2372 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2373 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2374 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2375 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2376 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2377 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2378 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2379
2380 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2381 @end deffn
2382
2383 @section Interface Drivers
2384
2385 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2386 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2387 available at run time.
2388
2389 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2390 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2391 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2392 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2393
2394 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2395 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2396 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2397 @end deffn
2398
2399 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2400 Displays status of RTCK option.
2401 Optionally sets that option first.
2402 @end deffn
2403 @end deffn
2404
2405 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2406 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2407 This has one driver-specific command:
2408
2409 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2410 Logs some status
2411 @end deffn
2412 @end deffn
2413
2414 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2415 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2416 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2417 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2418 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2419 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2420 @end deffn
2421
2422 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2423 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2424
2425 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2426 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2427 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2428 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2429 @example
2430 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2431 @end example
2432 @end deffn
2433
2434 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2435 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2436 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2437 @end deffn
2438
2439 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2440 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2441 @end deffn
2442 @end deffn
2443
2444 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2445 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2449 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2450 @end deffn
2451
2452 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2453 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2454 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2455
2456 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2457 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2458
2459 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2460 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2461
2462 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2463 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2464 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2465 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2466 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2467 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2468
2469 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2470 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2471 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2472 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2473 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2474
2475 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2476 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2477 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2478 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2479
2480 @itemize @minus
2481 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2482 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2483 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2484 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2485 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2486 switching data and direction as necessary
2487 @end itemize
2488
2489 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2490 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2491
2492 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2493 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2494 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2495 @example
2496 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2497 @end example
2498 @end deffn
2499
2500 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2501 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2502 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2503 during device selection.
2504 @end deffn
2505
2506 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2507 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2508 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2509 is connected to the host.
2510 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2511 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2512 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2513 @end deffn
2514
2515 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2516 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2517 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2518
2519 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2520 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2521 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2522 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2523 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2524
2525 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2526 @end deffn
2527
2528 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2529 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2530 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2531 @end deffn
2532
2533 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2534 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2535 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2536 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2537 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2538 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2539 and initially asserted reset signals.
2540 @end deffn
2541
2542 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2543 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2544 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2545 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2546 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2547 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2548 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2549 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2550 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2551 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2552 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2553
2554 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2555 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2556 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2557 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2558 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2559 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2560
2561 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2562 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2563 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2564 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2565 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2566 are always driven by the FTDI.
2567
2568 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2569 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2570 @var{name}.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2574 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2575 @itemize @minus
2576 @item @option{0}, drive low
2577 @item @option{1}, drive high
2578 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2579 @end itemize
2580 @end deffn
2581
2582 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2583 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2584 @end deffn
2585
2586 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2587 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2588
2589 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2590 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2591 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2592 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2593 @itemize @minus
2594 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2595 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2596 @end itemize
2597 @end deffn
2598
2599 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2600 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2601
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2605 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2606 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2607 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2608
2609 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2610 @itemize @minus
2611 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2612 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2613 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2614 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2615 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2616 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2617 @end itemize
2618
2619 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2620 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2621 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2622 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2623 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2624 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2625 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2626 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2627
2628 FT232R
2629 @itemize @minus
2630 @item bit 7 - RI
2631 @item bit 6 - DCD
2632 @item bit 5 - DSR
2633 @item bit 4 - DTR
2634 @item bit 3 - CTS
2635 @item bit 2 - RTS
2636 @item bit 1 - RXD
2637 @item bit 0 - TXD
2638 @end itemize
2639
2640 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2641 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2642
2643 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2644 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2645 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2646 @end deffn
2647
2648 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2649 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2650 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2651 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2652 @end deffn
2653
2654 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2655 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2656 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2660 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2661 @end deffn
2662
2663 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2664 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2665 @end deffn
2666
2667 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2668 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2669 @end deffn
2670
2671 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2672 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2673 @end deffn
2674
2675 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2676 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2680 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2681 @end deffn
2682
2683 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2684 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2685 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2686 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2687 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2688 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2689 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2690 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2691 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2692 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2693 @end deffn
2694
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2698 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2699 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2700 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2701
2702 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2703 processors which are being simulated.
2704
2705 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2706 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2707 sockets instead of TCP.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2711 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2712 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2713 @end deffn
2714
2715 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2716 something like:
2717
2718 @example
2719 interface remote_bitbang
2720 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2721 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2722 @end example
2723
2724 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2725 named mysocket:
2726
2727 @example
2728 interface remote_bitbang
2729 remote_bitbang_port 0
2730 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2731 @end example
2732 @end deffn
2733
2734 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2735 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2736 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2737 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2738
2739 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2740 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2741 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2742 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2743 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2747 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2748 default values are used.
2749 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2750 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2751 @example
2752 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2753 @end example
2754 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2755 @example
2756 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2757 @end example
2758 @end deffn
2759
2760 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2761 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2762 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2763 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2764 target board.
2765
2766 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2767 @example
2768 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2769 reset_config srst_only
2770 @end example
2771 @end deffn
2772
2773 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2774 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2775 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2776 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2777 @end deffn
2778
2779 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2780 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2781 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2782 @end deffn
2783
2784 @end deffn
2785
2786 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2787 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2788 This has one driver-specific command:
2789
2790 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2791 Display either the address of the I/O port
2792 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2793 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2794 This is a write-once setting.
2795 @end deffn
2796 @end deffn
2797
2798 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2799 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2800 transports.
2801
2802 @quotation Compatibility Note
2803 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2804 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2805 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2806 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2807 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2808 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2809 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2810 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2811 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2812 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2813 @end quotation
2814
2815 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2816 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2817 states.
2818 @end deffn
2819 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2820 Display free device internal memory.
2821 @end deffn
2822 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2823 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2824 command version.
2825 @end deffn
2826 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2827 Display the device configuration.
2828 @end deffn
2829 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2830 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2831 power state.
2832 @end deffn
2833 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2834 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2835 @end deffn
2836 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2837 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2838 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2839 IP configuration.
2840 @end deffn
2841 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2842 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2843 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2844 @end deffn
2845 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2846 Reset the current configuration.
2847 @end deffn
2848 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2849 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2850 @end deffn
2851 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2852 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2853 pairs.
2854
2855 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2856 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2857 @example
2858 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2859 @end example
2860 @end deffn
2861 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2862 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2863 pairs.
2864
2865 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2866 @example
2867 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2868 77a90000
2869 @end example
2870 @end deffn
2871 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2872 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2873 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2874 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2875 instead.
2876
2877 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2880 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2881 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2882
2883 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2884 @end deffn
2885 @end deffn
2886
2887 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2888 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2889 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2890 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2891 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2892 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2893 configuration script.
2894
2895 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2896 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2897 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2898 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2899 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2900
2901 Known limitations:
2902 @itemize @bullet
2903 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2904 and 2.7 MHz.
2905 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2906 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2907 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2908 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2909 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2910 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2911 communications with the target.
2912 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2913 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2914 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2915 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2916 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2917 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2918 @end itemize
2919
2920 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2921 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2922 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2923 @end deffn
2924
2925 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2926 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2927 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2928 @end deffn
2929
2930 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2931 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2932 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2933 target as a side-effect.
2934 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2935 @end deffn
2936
2937 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2938 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2939 version, and target voltage.
2940 @end deffn
2941 @end deffn
2942
2943 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2944 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2945 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2946 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2947 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2948
2949 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2950 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2951 This is a write-once setting.
2952 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2953
2954 @itemize @minus
2955 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2956 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2957 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2958 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2959 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2960 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2961 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2962 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2963 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2964 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2965 some versions of
2966 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2967 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2968 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2969 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2970 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2971 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2972 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2973 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2974 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2975 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2976 @end itemize
2977 @end deffn
2978
2979 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2980 Display either the address of the I/O port
2981 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2982 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2983 This is a write-once setting.
2984
2985 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2986 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2987 you may encounter a problem.
2988 @end deffn
2989
2990 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2991 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2992 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2993 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2994 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2995 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2996
2997 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2998 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2999 @quotation Tip
3000 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3001 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3002 @example
3003 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3004 > adapter_khz 500
3005 @end example
3006 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3007 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3008 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3009 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3010 large set of samples.
3011 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3012 @example
3013 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3014 @end example
3015 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
3016 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3017
3018 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3019 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3020 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3021 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3022 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
3023 @end quotation
3024 @end deffn
3025
3026 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3027 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3028 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3029 @end deffn
3030
3031 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3032 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3033
3034 @example
3035 interface parport
3036 parport_port 0x278
3037 parport_cable wiggler
3038 @end example
3039 @end deffn
3040
3041 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3042 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3043 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3044 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3045 @end deffn
3046 @end deffn
3047
3048 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3049 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3050 @end deffn
3051
3052 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3053 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3054 @end deffn
3055
3056 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3057 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3058
3059 @quotation Note
3060 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3061 which are not currently documented here.
3062 @end quotation
3063 @end deffn
3064
3065 @anchor{hla_interface}
3066 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3067 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3068 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3069 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3070
3071 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
3072 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3073 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3074 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3075 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3078 Currently Not Supported.
3079 @end deffn
3080
3081 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3082 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3083 @end deffn
3084
3085 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
3086 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3087 @end deffn
3088
3089 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3090 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3091 @end deffn
3092
3093 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3094 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3095 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3096 @end deffn
3097 @end deffn
3098
3099 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3100 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3101 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3102 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3103 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3104
3105 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3106 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3107 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3108 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3109
3110 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3111 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3112
3113 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3114 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3115 @end deffn
3116
3117 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3118 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3119 @end deffn
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3123 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3127 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3128 @end deffn
3129
3130 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3131 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3132 @end deffn
3133
3134 @quotation Note
3135 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3136 which are not currently documented here.
3137 @end quotation
3138
3139 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3140 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3141 No arguments: print status.
3142 @end deffn
3143
3144 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3145 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3146 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3147
3148 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3149 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3150 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3151 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3152 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3153 configuration on exit.
3154
3155 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3156 pinout.
3157
3158 @end deffn
3159
3160 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3161 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3162 of the one which is most popular.
3163
3164 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3165
3166 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3167 pinout.
3168
3169 @end deffn
3170
3171
3172 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3173 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3174 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3175
3176 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3177 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3178 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3179
3180 @itemize @minus
3181 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3182 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3183 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3184 @end itemize
3185 @end deffn
3186
3187 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3188 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3189 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3190 @end deffn
3191 @end deffn
3192
3193 @section Transport Configuration
3194 @cindex Transport
3195 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3196 and the debug adapter you are using,
3197 several transports may be available to
3198 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3199 @deffn Command {transport list}
3200 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3201 version of OpenOCD.
3202 @end deffn
3203
3204 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3205 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3206
3207 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3208 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3209 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3210 adapter's driver).
3211
3212 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3213 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3214 supported by the debug adapter.
3215
3216 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3217 transport, if any.
3218 @end deffn
3219
3220 @subsection JTAG Transport
3221 @cindex JTAG
3222 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3223 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3224 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3225 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3226 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3227 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3228
3229 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3230 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3231 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3232 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3233 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3234
3235 @subsection SWD Transport
3236 @cindex SWD
3237 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3238 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3239 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3240 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3241 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3242 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3243 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3244
3245 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3246 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3247 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3248 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3249 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3250
3251 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3252 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3253 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3254 expected to change.
3255 @end deffn
3256 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3257 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3258 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3259 No parameters: displays current settings.
3260 @end deffn
3261
3262 @subsection SPI Transport
3263 @cindex SPI
3264 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3265 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3266 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3267 solution for flash programming.
3268
3269 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3270 @section JTAG Speed
3271 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3272 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3273 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3274 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3275 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3276 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3277 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3278 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3279 power management software that may be active.
3280
3281 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3282 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3283 target event handler.
3284 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3285 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3286 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3287 sets up those clocks).
3288 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3289 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3290 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3291 in the target config file.
3292 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3293 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3294 config file instead.
3295 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3296 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3297 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3298
3299 @example
3300 jtag_rclk 3000
3301 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3302 @end example
3303
3304 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3305 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3306 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3307 may not be the fastest solution.
3308
3309 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3310 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3311 which support adaptive clocking.
3312
3313 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3314 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3315 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3316 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3317 than the speed specified.
3318
3319 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3320 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3321 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3322 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3323
3324 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3325 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3326 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3327 JTAG clocking after setup.
3328 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3329 If the interface device can not
3330 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3331 @end deffn
3332
3333 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3334 @cindex adaptive clocking
3335 @cindex RTCK
3336 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3337 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3338 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3339 @example
3340 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3341 jtag_rclk 3000
3342 @end example
3343 @end defun
3344
3345 @node Reset Configuration
3346 @chapter Reset Configuration
3347 @cindex Reset Configuration
3348
3349 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3350 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3351 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3352 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3353 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3354 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3355 Please see the various board files for examples.
3356
3357 @quotation Note
3358 To maintainers and integrators:
3359 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3360 Normally the board configuration file
3361 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3362 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3363
3364 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3365 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3366 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3367 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3368 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3369 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3370 @end quotation
3371
3372 @section Types of Reset
3373
3374 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3375 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3376 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3377
3378 @itemize @bullet
3379 @item
3380 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3381 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3382 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3383 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3384 @item
3385 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3386 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3387 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3388 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3389 @item
3390 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3391 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3392 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3393 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3394 @item
3395 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3396 several other types of reset.
3397 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3398 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3399 There may be individual module resets.
3400 @end itemize
3401
3402 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3403 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3404 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3405 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3406 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3407 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3408 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3409 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3410 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3411
3412 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3413 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3414
3415 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3416 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3417 common issues are:
3418
3419 @itemize @bullet
3420
3421 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3422 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3423 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3424 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3425 when either of those signals is not connected.
3426 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3427 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3428 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3429 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3430
3431 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3432 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3433 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3434 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3435
3436 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3437 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3438 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3439 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3440 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3441 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3442 hardware debouncing.
3443 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3444 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3445
3446 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3447 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3448 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3449 to use push/pull output drivers.
3450 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3451 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3452 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3453 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3454
3455 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3456 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3457 issues (not limited to errata).
3458 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3459 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3460 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3461 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3462 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3463 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3464 @end itemize
3465
3466 There can also be other issues.
3467 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3468 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3469 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3470 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3471 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3472 Agreement (NDA).
3473
3474 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3475 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3476 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3477
3478 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3479 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3480
3481 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3482
3483 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3484 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3485 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3486 allowing it to be deasserted.
3487 @end deffn
3488
3489 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3490 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3491 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3492 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3493 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3494 @end deffn
3495
3496 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3497 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3498 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3499 allowing it to be deasserted.
3500 @end deffn
3501
3502 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3503 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3504 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3505 @end deffn
3506
3507 @anchor{reset_config}
3508 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3509 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3510 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3511 configuration scripts.
3512
3513 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3514 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3515 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3516 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3517 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3518 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3519 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3520 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3521
3522 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3523 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3524 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3525 -- may be specified at a time.
3526 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3527 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3528 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3529 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3530 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3531
3532 @itemize
3533 @item
3534 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3535 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3536 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3537 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3538 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3539
3540 @quotation Tip
3541 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3542 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3543 @end quotation
3544
3545 @item
3546 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3547 signal implementations.
3548 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3549 indicating everything behaves normally.
3550 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3551 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3552 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3553 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3554 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3555 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3556 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3557
3558 @item
3559 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3560 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3561 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3562 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3563 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3564 while SRST is asserted.
3565 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3566 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3567
3568 @item
3569 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3570 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3571 is required to use this option.
3572 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3573 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3574 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3575 be asserted before any target connection.
3576 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3577 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3578 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3579 @end itemize
3580
3581 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3582 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3583 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3584 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3585 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3586
3587 @itemize
3588 @item
3589 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3590 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3591 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3592 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3593
3594 @item
3595 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3596 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3597 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3598 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3599 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3600 @end itemize
3601 @end deffn
3602
3603 @section Custom Reset Handling
3604 @cindex events
3605
3606 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3607 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3608 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3609 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3610 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3611 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3612
3613 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3614 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3615 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3616 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3617 want to reset everything at once.
3618
3619 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3620 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3621 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3622 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3623 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3624 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3625 needs special attention.
3626
3627 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3628 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3629 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3630 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3631 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3632 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3633 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3634 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3635 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3636
3637 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3638 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3639 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3640 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3641 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3642
3643 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3644 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3645 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3646 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3647 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3648 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3649 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3650 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3651 or potentially some other value.
3652
3653 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3654 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3655 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3656 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3657 (or their associated targets)
3658 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3659
3660 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3661 they return.
3662 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3663 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3664 @end deffn
3665
3666 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3667 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3668 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3669 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3670 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3671 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3672 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3673 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3674 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3675 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3676 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3677 @end deffn
3678
3679 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3680 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3681 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3682 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3683 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3684 @end deffn
3685
3686
3687 @node TAP Declaration
3688 @chapter TAP Declaration
3689 @cindex TAP declaration
3690 @cindex TAP configuration
3691
3692 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3693 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3694
3695 @itemize @bullet
3696 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3697 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3698 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3699 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3700 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3701 start running that code.
3702 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3703 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3704 and missing connections.
3705 @end itemize
3706
3707 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3708 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3709 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3710 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3711 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3712
3713 @section Scan Chains
3714 @cindex scan chain
3715
3716 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3717 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3718 They also need to be added to
3719 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3720 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3721 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3722 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3723 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3724 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3725 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3726 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3727
3728 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3729 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3730 command, presented in the next chapter.
3731 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3732 debugging targets.)
3733 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3734
3735 @verbatim
3736 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3737 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3738 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3739 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3740 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3741 @end verbatim
3742
3743 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3744 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3745 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3746 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3747 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3748 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3749 until they are told to do so.
3750
3751 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3752 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3753 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3754 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3755
3756 @example
3757 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3758 @end example
3759
3760 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3761 by a given chip.
3762 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3763 and so forth.
3764 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3765 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3766 both inside a single chip and between them.
3767 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3768
3769 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3770 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3771 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3772 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3773 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3774 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3775 includes commands something like this:
3776
3777 @example
3778 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3779 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3780 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3781 @end example
3782
3783 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3784 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3785 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3786
3787 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3788 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3789 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3790 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3791 @example
3792 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3793 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3794 @}
3795 @end example
3796 @end deffn
3797
3798 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3799 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3800 and their status.
3801 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3802 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3803 but systems with a JTAG router can
3804 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3805 @end deffn
3806
3807 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3808 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3809
3810 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3811 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3812
3813 @section TAP Names
3814 @cindex dotted name
3815
3816 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3817 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3818 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3819 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3820 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3821 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3822 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3823 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3824
3825 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3826 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3827 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3828
3829 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3830
3831 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3832 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3833 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3834 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3835
3836 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3837 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3838 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3839 overridable.
3840
3841 @cindex TAP naming convention
3842 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3843 and should follow this convention:
3844
3845 @itemize @bullet
3846 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3847 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3848 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3849 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3850 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3851 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3852 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3853 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3854 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3855 with a single TAP;
3856 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3857 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3858 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3859 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3860 @end itemize
3861
3862 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3863
3864 @itemize @bullet
3865 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3866 @*The length in bits of the
3867 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3868 @end itemize
3869
3870 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3871
3872 @itemize @bullet
3873 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3874 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3875 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3876 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3877 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3878 (the TAP is linked in).
3879 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3880 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3881 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3882 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3883 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3884 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3885 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3886 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3887 values that were found but not included in the list.
3888
3889 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3890 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3891 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3892 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3893 hardware to find these values.
3894 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3895 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3896 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3897 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3898 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3899 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3900 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3901 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3902 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3903 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3904 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3905 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3906 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3907 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3908 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3909 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3910 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3911 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3912 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3913 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3914 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3915 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3916 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3917 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3918 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3919 @end itemize
3920 @end deffn
3921
3922 @section Other TAP commands
3923
3924 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
3925 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
3926 @end deffn
3927
3928 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3929 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3930 At this writing this TAP attribute
3931 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
3932 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3933 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3934 See the next section for information about the available events.
3935
3936 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3937 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3938 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3939 @end deffn
3940
3941 @section TAP Events
3942 @cindex events
3943 @cindex TAP events
3944
3945 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3946 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3947 The other applies to debugger targets,
3948 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3949
3950 The TAP events currently defined are:
3951
3952 @itemize @bullet
3953 @item @b{post-reset}
3954 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3955 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3956 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3957 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3958 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3959
3960 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3961 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3962 of any particular target.
3963 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3964 @item @b{setup}
3965 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3966 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3967 @item @b{tap-disable}
3968 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3969 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3970 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3971 @item @b{tap-enable}
3972 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3973 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3974 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3975 @end itemize
3976
3977 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3978 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3979 contents to be accurate), you might:
3980
3981 @example
3982 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3983 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3984 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3985 @}
3986 @end example
3987
3988
3989 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3990 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3991 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3992 @cindex jrc
3993
3994 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3995 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3996 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3997 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3998 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3999
4000 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4001 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4002 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4003 be visible.
4004 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4005 ignores, such as:
4006
4007 @itemize
4008 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4009 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4010 TAPs receive new instructions.
4011 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4012 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4013 @end itemize
4014
4015 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4016 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4017 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4018 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4019
4020 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4021 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4022
4023 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4024 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4025 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4026 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4027 should define TAP event handlers using
4028 code that looks something like this:
4029
4030 @example
4031 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4032 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4033 @}
4034 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4035 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4036 @}
4037 @end example
4038
4039 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4040
4041 @example
4042 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4043 @end example
4044
4045 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4046 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4047 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4048 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4049
4050 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4051 If necessary, disables the tap
4052 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4053 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4054 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4055 and "0" if it is disabled.
4056 @end deffn
4057
4058 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4059 If necessary, enables the tap
4060 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4061 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4062 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4063 and "0" if it is disabled.
4064 @end deffn
4065
4066 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4067 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4068 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4069 and "0" if it is disabled.
4070
4071 @quotation Note
4072 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4073 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4074 @end quotation
4075 @end deffn
4076
4077 @anchor{autoprobing}
4078 @section Autoprobing
4079 @cindex autoprobe
4080 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4081
4082 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4083 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4084 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4085 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4086
4087 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4088 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4089 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4090 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4091 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4092 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4093 right when they come out of reset).
4094
4095 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4096
4097 @example
4098 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4099 reset_config trst_and_srst
4100 jtag_rclk 8
4101 @end example
4102
4103 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4104 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4105
4106 @enumerate
4107 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4108 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4109 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4110 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4111 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4112 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4113 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4114 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4115 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4116 that is discovered.
4117 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4118 register, it will report it.
4119 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4120 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4121 @end enumerate
4122
4123 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4124 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4125 that's a bit more complex:
4126
4127 @example
4128 clock speed 8 kHz
4129 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4130 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4131 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4132 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4133 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4134 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4135 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4136 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4137 @end example
4138
4139 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4140 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4141 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4142 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4143 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4144 and so forth.
4145
4146 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4147 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4148 @cindex DAP declaration
4149
4150 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4151 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4152 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4153 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4154 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4155
4156 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4157
4158 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4159 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4160 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4161 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4162 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4163
4164 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4165
4166 @itemize @bullet
4167 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4168 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4169 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4170 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4171 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4172 @end itemize
4173 @end deffn
4174
4175 @deffn Command {dap names}
4176 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4177 for TCL scripting.
4178 @end deffn
4179
4180 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4181 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4182 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4183 @end deffn
4184
4185 @deffn Command {dap init}
4186 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4187 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4188 initialization, too.
4189 @end deffn
4190
4191 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4192
4193 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4194 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4195 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4196 @end deffn
4197
4198 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4199 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4200 @end deffn
4201
4202 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4203 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4204 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4205 or set a new value @var{value}.
4206 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4207 @end deffn
4208
4209 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4210 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4211 @end deffn
4212
4213 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4214 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4215 value @var{value}.
4216
4217 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4218 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4219 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4220
4221 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4222 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4223 @end deffn
4224
4225 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4226 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4227 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4228 @end deffn
4229
4230 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4231 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4232 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4233 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4234 @end deffn
4235
4236 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4237 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4238
4239 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4240 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4241 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4242 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4243 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4244 for details.
4245
4246 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4247 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4248 the pattern:
4249 @example
4250 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4251 @end example
4252
4253 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4254 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4255 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4256 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4257 @example
4258 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4259 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4260 @end example
4261
4262 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4263 @example
4264 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4265 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4266 @end example
4267
4268 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4269 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4270
4271 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4272 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4273 example with a proper dap name:
4274 @example
4275 xxx.dap apcsw default
4276 @end example
4277 @end deffn
4278
4279 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4280 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4281 Disabled by default
4282 @end deffn
4283
4284
4285 @node CPU Configuration
4286 @chapter CPU Configuration
4287 @cindex GDB target
4288
4289 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4290 You can also access these targets without GDB
4291 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4292 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4293 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4294 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4295
4296 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4297 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4298
4299 @section Target List
4300 @cindex target, current
4301 @cindex target, list
4302
4303 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4304 where each member has a name.
4305 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4306 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4307 (plural!) command.
4308 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4309 look like with more than one:
4310 @verbatim
4311 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4312 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4313 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4314 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4315 @end verbatim
4316
4317 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4318 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4319 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4320 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4321 space seen by that current target.
4322 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4323 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4324 are examples; and there are many more.
4325
4326 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4327
4328 @deffn Command {target current}
4329 Returns the name of the current target.
4330 @end deffn
4331
4332 @deffn Command {target names}
4333 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4334 @example
4335 foreach t [target names] @{
4336 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4337 @}
4338 @end example
4339 @end deffn
4340
4341 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4342 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4343
4344 @deffn Command targets [name]
4345 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4346 command names are singular.}
4347
4348 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4349 targets in a user friendly form.
4350
4351 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4352 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4353 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4354 @end deffn
4355
4356 @section Target CPU Types
4357 @cindex target type
4358 @cindex CPU type
4359
4360 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4361 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4362 when calling @command{target create}.
4363 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4364 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4365 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4366 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4367 what core-specific commands may be available
4368 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4369 and more.
4370
4371 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4372 since there's a command to list them.
4373
4374 @anchor{targettypes}
4375 @deffn Command {target types}
4376 Lists all supported target types.
4377 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4378
4379 @itemize @bullet
4380 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4381 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4382 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4383 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4384 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4385 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4386 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4387 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4388 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4389 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4390 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4391 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4392 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4393 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4394 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4395 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4396 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4397 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4398 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4399 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4400 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4401 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4402 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4403 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4404 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4405 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4406 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4407 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4408 @itemize @minus
4409 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4410 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4411 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4412 @end itemize
4413 And two debug interfaces cores:
4414 @itemize @minus
4415 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4416 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4417 @end itemize
4418 @end itemize
4419 @end deffn
4420
4421 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4422 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4423 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4424 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4425 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4426 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4427 reflect design generations;
4428 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4429 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4430
4431 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4432 @section Target Configuration
4433
4434 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4435 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4436 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4437 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4438 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4439
4440 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4441 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4442 optional parts.
4443 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4444 command, created as part of target creation.
4445
4446 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4447 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4448 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4449 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4450 to be much more board-specific.
4451 The key steps you use might look something like this
4452
4453 @example
4454 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4455 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4456 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4457 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4458 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4459 @end example
4460
4461 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4462 on-chip SRAM.
4463 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4464 writes to target memory;
4465 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4466 GDB memory checksumming;
4467 and more.
4468
4469 @quotation Warning
4470 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4471 inaccessible when application code
4472 (such as an operating system)
4473 enables or disables the MMU.
4474 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4475 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4476 easy access to other addresses needed.
4477 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4478 @end quotation
4479
4480 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4481 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4482 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4483 controllers.
4484 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4485 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4486 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4487
4488 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4489 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4490 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4491 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4492 purposes including additional configuration.
4493
4494 @itemize @bullet
4495 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4496 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4497 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4498 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4499
4500 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4501 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4502 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4503 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4504 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4505 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4506 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4507
4508 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4509 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4510 @end itemize
4511 @end deffn
4512
4513 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4514 The options accepted by this command may also be
4515 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4516 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4517 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4518
4519 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4520 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4521 and changing its endianness.
4522
4523 @itemize @bullet
4524
4525 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4526 used to access this target.
4527
4528 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4529 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4530 create and manage DAP instances.
4531
4532 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4533 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4534
4535 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4536 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4537 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4538 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4539 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4540 same event name assigns only one handler.
4541
4542 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4543 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4544
4545 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4546 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4547 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4548 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4549 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4550 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4551 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4552
4553 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4554 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4555 or virtual address is being used.
4556
4557 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4558 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4559
4560 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4561 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4562 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4563 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4564 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4565
4566 @anchor{rtostype}
4567 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4568 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4569 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4570 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4571 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4572
4573 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4574 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4575 access the target for debugging.
4576
4577 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4578 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4579 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4580 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4581
4582 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4583 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4584 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4585 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4586 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4587
4588 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4589 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4590 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4591 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4592 command @command{gdb_port}.
4593 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4594 @end itemize
4595 @end deffn
4596
4597 @section Other $target_name Commands
4598 @cindex object command
4599
4600 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4601 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4602
4603 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4604 Once a button is created a button
4605 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4606 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4607 configure it like this:
4608
4609 @example
4610 # Create
4611 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4612 # Modify
4613 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4614 # Query
4615 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4616 # Report
4617 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4618 @end example
4619
4620 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4621 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4622
4623 @example
4624 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4625 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4626 @end example
4627
4628 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4629
4630 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4631 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4632 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4633 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4634 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4635 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4636 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4637 They are not otherwise documented here.
4638 @end deffn
4639
4640 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4641 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4642 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4643 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4644 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4645 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4646 the target side uses raw memory.
4647
4648 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4649 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4650 The script orientation comes from working with data
4651 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4652 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4653 and neither store nor return those values.
4654
4655 @itemize
4656 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4657 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4658 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4659 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4660 @end itemize
4661 @end deffn
4662
4663 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4664 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4665 @command{$target_name configure}
4666 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4667 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4668 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4669 There are a few special cases:
4670
4671 @itemize @bullet
4672 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4673 event named @var{event_name}.
4674 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4675 two parameters.
4676 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4677 This is a special case because this is set using
4678 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4679 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4680 @end itemize
4681
4682 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4683 all the targets you might use something like this:
4684
4685 @example
4686 foreach name [target names] @{
4687 set y [$name cget -endian]
4688 set z [$name cget -type]
4689 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4690 $x $name $y $z]
4691 @}
4692 @end example
4693 @end deffn
4694
4695 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4696 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4697 Displays the current target state:
4698 @code{debug-running},
4699 @code{halted},
4700 @code{reset},
4701 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4702 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4703 @end deffn
4704
4705 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4706 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4707 currently associated with this target.
4708 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4709 @end deffn
4710
4711 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4712 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4713 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4714 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4715 @end deffn
4716
4717 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4718 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4719 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4720 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4721 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4722 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4723 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4724 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4725 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4726 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4727 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4728 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4729 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4730 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4731 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4732 @end deffn
4733
4734 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4735 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4736 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4737 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4738 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4739 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4740 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4741 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4742 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4743 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4744 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4745 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4746 @end deffn
4747
4748 @anchor{targetevents}
4749 @section Target Events
4750 @cindex target events
4751 @cindex events
4752 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4753 For example:
4754 @itemize @bullet
4755 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4756 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4757 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4758 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4759 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4760 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4761 to set up system clocks or
4762 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4763 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4764 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4765 @end itemize
4766
4767 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4768 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4769 @command{target create ... -event}.
4770
4771 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4772 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4773 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4774
4775 @example
4776 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4777 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4778 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4779 @}
4780 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4781 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4782 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4783 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4784 @}
4785 @end example
4786
4787 The following target events are defined:
4788
4789 @itemize @bullet
4790 @item @b{debug-halted}
4791 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4792 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4793 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4794 @item @b{early-halted}
4795 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4796 @item @b{examine-start}
4797 @* Before target examine is called.
4798 @item @b{examine-end}
4799 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4800 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4801 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4802 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4803 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4804 connect GDB to running target.
4805 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4806 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4807 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4808 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4809 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4810 is in RAM or read only memory.
4811 Default is @code{halt}
4812 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4813 @* When GDB disconnects
4814 @item @b{gdb-end}
4815 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4816 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4817 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4818 @code{reset init})
4819 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4820 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4821 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4822 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4823 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4824 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4825 @item @b{gdb-start}
4826 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4827 @item @b{halted}
4828 @* The target has halted
4829 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4830 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4831 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4832 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4833 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4834 @item @b{reset-assert}
4835 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4836 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4837 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4838 it instead of asserting SRST.
4839 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4840 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4841 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4842 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4843 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4844 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4845 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4846 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4847 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4848 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4849 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4850 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4851 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4852 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4853 released on the scan chain.
4854 @item @b{reset-end}
4855 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4856 @item @b{reset-init}
4857 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4858 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4859
4860 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4861 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4862 multiplexing, and so on.
4863 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4864 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4865 @item @b{reset-start}
4866 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4867 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4868
4869 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4870 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4871 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4872 @item @b{resume-start}
4873 @* Before any target is resumed
4874 @item @b{resume-end}
4875 @* After all targets have resumed
4876 @item @b{resumed}
4877 @* Target has resumed
4878 @item @b{trace-config}
4879 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4880 @end itemize
4881
4882 @node Flash Commands
4883 @chapter Flash Commands
4884
4885 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4886 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4887 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4888 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4889 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4890 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4891 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4892 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4893 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4894
4895 Flash Steps:
4896 @enumerate
4897 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4898 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4899 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4900 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4901 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4902 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4903 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4904 @item GDB Flashing
4905 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4906 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4907 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4908 @end enumerate
4909
4910 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4911 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4912 so that it can't boot.
4913 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4914 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4915
4916 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4917 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4918 @cindex flash configuration
4919
4920 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4921 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4922 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4923 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4924 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4925 see the driver-specific documentation.
4926
4927 @itemize @bullet
4928 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4929 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4930 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4931 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4932 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4933 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4934 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4935 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4936 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4937 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4938 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4939 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4940 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4941 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4942 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4943 commands to the flash controller.
4944 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4945 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4946 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4947 for more information.
4948 @end itemize
4949 @quotation Note
4950 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4951 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4952 @end quotation
4953 @end deffn
4954
4955 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4956 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4957 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4958 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4959 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4960 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4961 @end deffn
4962
4963 @deffn Command {flash list}
4964 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4965 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4966 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4967 @end deffn
4968
4969 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4970 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4971 depends on the flash type.
4972 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4973 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4974 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4975 but most don't bother.
4976 @end deffn
4977
4978 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
4979
4980 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
4981 begins.
4982
4983 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
4984 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
4985 until the programming session is finished.
4986
4987 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
4988 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
4989
4990 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
4991
4992 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4993 @cindex flash erasing
4994 @cindex flash reading
4995 @cindex flash writing
4996 @cindex flash programming
4997 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4998
4999 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5000 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5001 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5002 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5003 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5004
5005 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5006 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5007 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5008 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5009 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5010
5011 @quotation Note
5012 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5013 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5014 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5015 back to a flash bank.
5016 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5017 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5018 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5019 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5020 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5021 @end quotation
5022
5023 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5024 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5025 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5026 disabled first.
5027 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5028 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5029 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5030
5031 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5032 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5033 up to and including @var{last}.
5034 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5035 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5036 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5037 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5038 @end deffn
5039
5040 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5041 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5042 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5043 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5044 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5045 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5046 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5047 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5048 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5049 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5050 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5051 before erase starts.
5052 @end deffn
5053
5054 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
5055 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5056 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5057 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
5058 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5059 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5060 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5061 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5062 before issuing this command.
5063 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5064 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5065 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5066 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5067 @end deffn
5068 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5069
5070 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5071 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5072 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5073 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5074 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5075 @end deffn
5076
5077 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5078 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5079 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5080 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5081 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5082 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5083 @end deffn
5084
5085 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5086 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5087 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5088 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5089 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5090 @end deffn
5091
5092 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5093 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5094 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5095 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5096 to the base address for each section in the image.
5097 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5098 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5099 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5100 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5101 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5102 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5103 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5104 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5105 each image section.
5106
5107 @quotation Warning
5108 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5109 data you want to preserve.
5110 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5111 sections might be erased with no notice.
5112 @itemize
5113 @item
5114 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5115 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5116 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5117 @item
5118 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5119 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5120 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5121 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5122 @end itemize
5123 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5124 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5125 @end quotation
5126
5127 @end deffn
5128
5129 @section Other Flash commands
5130 @cindex flash protection
5131
5132 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5133 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5134 and display that status.
5135 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5136 @end deffn
5137
5138 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5139 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5140 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5141
5142 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5143 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5144 and possibly stale information.
5145 @end deffn
5146
5147 @anchor{flashprotect}
5148 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5149 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5150 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5151 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5152 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5153 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5154 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5155 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5156 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5157 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5158 @end deffn
5159
5160 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5161 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5162 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5163 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5164 @end deffn
5165
5166 @anchor{program}
5167 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5168 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5169 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5170 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5171 @end deffn
5172
5173 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5174 @section Flash Driver List
5175 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5176 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5177 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5178
5179 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5180 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5181 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5182
5183 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5184
5185 @itemize
5186 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5187 @end itemize
5188
5189 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5190 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5191 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5192 @example
5193 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5194 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5195 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5196 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5197 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5198 @end example
5199 @end deffn
5200
5201 @subsection External Flash
5202
5203 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5204 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5205 @cindex CFI
5206 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5207 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5208 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5209 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5210 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5211 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5212 configure a bus and its timings), or
5213 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5214 on the flash chip.
5215 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5216 speed up operation.
5217
5218 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5219
5220 @itemize
5221 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5222 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5223 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5224 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5225 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5226 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5227 @end itemize
5228
5229 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5230 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5231
5232 @example
5233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5234 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5235 @end example
5236
5237 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5238 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5239 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5240
5241 @example
5242 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5243 @end example
5244
5245 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5246 @end deffn
5247
5248 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5249 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5250 @cindex SPI
5251 @cindex jtagspi
5252 @cindex bscan_spi
5253 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5254 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5255 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5256 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5257 accessed through JTAG.
5258
5259 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5260 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5261 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5262 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5263 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5264 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5265
5266 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5267 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5268 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5269 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5270 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5271 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5272 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5273 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5274
5275 @itemize
5276 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5277 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5278 @var{USER1} instruction.
5279 @end itemize
5280
5281 @example
5282 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5283 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5284 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5285 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5286 @end example
5287 @end deffn
5288
5289 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5290 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5291 @cindex xcf
5292 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5293 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5294 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5295 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5296 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5297
5298 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5299 command accepts additional parameters:
5300 @itemize
5301 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5302 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5303 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5304 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5305 in master mode.
5306 @end itemize
5307 @example
5308 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5309 @end example
5310 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5311 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5312 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5313 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5314 dedicated sector.
5315 @end deffn
5316
5317 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5318 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5319 button.
5320 @example
5321 xcf configure 0
5322 @end example
5323 @end deffn
5324
5325 Additional driver notes:
5326 @itemize
5327 @item Only single revision supported.
5328 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5329 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5330 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5331 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5332 @end itemize
5333 @end deffn
5334
5335 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5336 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5337 @cindex SPIFI
5338 @cindex lpcspifi
5339 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5340 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5341 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5342
5343 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5344 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5345 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5346 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5347 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5348
5349 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5350 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5351 are configured by the driver.
5352
5353 @example
5354 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5355 @end example
5356
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5360 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5361 @cindex SMI
5362 @cindex stmsmi
5363 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5364 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5365 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5366 SPI flash devices.
5367 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5368 flash devices can be connected.
5369
5370 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5371 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5372 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5373 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5374 the flash content.
5375
5376 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5377 to identify the memory bank.
5378 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5379 flash size, are detected automatically.
5380
5381 @example
5382 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5383 @end example
5384
5385 @end deffn
5386
5387 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5388 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5389 Microcontroller platform.
5390
5391 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5392 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5393
5394 @example
5395 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5396 @end example
5397
5398 @end deffn
5399
5400 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5401 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5402 @cindex ath79
5403 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5404 chip selects.
5405 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5406 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5407 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5408 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5409 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5410 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5411
5412 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5413 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5414 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5415 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5416 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5417 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5418 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5419 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5420 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5421 with the default CS0.
5422 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5423 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5424 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5425
5426 @example
5427 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5428
5429 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5430 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5431 # banks.
5432 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5433 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5434 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5435 @end example
5436
5437 @end deffn
5438
5439 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5440 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5441 @cindex fespi
5442
5443 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5444
5445 @example
5446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5447 @end example
5448 @end deffn
5449
5450 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5451
5452 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5453 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5454 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5455 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5456 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5457 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5458
5459 @example
5460 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5461 @end example
5462 @end deffn
5463
5464 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5465 @cindex ambiqmicro
5466 @cindex apollo
5467 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5468 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5469 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5470 with the target using SWD.
5471
5472 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5473 the device class of the MCU.
5474 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5475 to set up the flash banks.
5476 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5477 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5478
5479 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5480 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5481 and the second bank starts after the first.
5482
5483 @example
5484 # Flash bank 0
5485 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5486 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5487 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5488 $_TARGETNAME
5489 @end example
5490
5491 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5492 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5493 are available to the user.
5494
5495 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5496
5497 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5498 Erase entire bank.
5499 @end deffn
5500 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5501 Erase device pages.
5502 @end deffn
5503 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5504 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5505 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5506 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5507 the flash.
5508 @end deffn
5509 @end deffn
5510
5511 @anchor{at91samd}
5512 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5513 @cindex at91samd
5514 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5515 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5516
5517 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5518
5519 The devices have one flash bank:
5520
5521 @example
5522 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5523 @end example
5524
5525 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5526 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5527 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5528 processor to be halted.
5529 @end deffn
5530
5531 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5532 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5533 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5534 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5535 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5536 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5537
5538 @example
5539 at91samd set-security enable
5540 @end example
5541 @end deffn
5542
5543 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5544 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5545 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5546 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5547 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5548 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5549 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5550 in order to disable this feature.
5551
5552 @example
5553 at91samd eeprom
5554 at91samd eeprom 1024
5555 @end example
5556 @end deffn
5557
5558 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5559 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5560 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5561 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5562 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5563 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5564
5565 @example
5566 at91samd bootloader
5567 at91samd bootloader 16384
5568 @end example
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5572 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5573 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5574 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5575 @end deffn
5576
5577 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5578 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5579 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5580 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5581 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5582 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5583 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5584 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5585
5586 @example
5587 # Read user row
5588 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5589 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5590 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5591 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5592 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5593 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5594 @end example
5595 @end deffn
5596
5597 @end deffn
5598
5599 @anchor{at91sam3}
5600 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5601 @cindex at91sam3
5602 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5603 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5604 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5605 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5606 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5607 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5608 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5609 chips are confirmed.}
5610
5611 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5612 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5613 the following fixed locations:
5614
5615 @example
5616 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5617 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5618 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5619 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5620 @end example
5621
5622 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5623 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5624 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5625
5626 @itemize
5627 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5628 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5629 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5630 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5631 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5632 @end itemize
5633
5634 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5635
5636 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5637 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5638 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5639 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5640 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5641 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5642 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5643
5644 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5645 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5646 @end deffn
5647
5648 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5649 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5650 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5651 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5652 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5653 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5654 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5655 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5656 @end deffn
5657
5658 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5659 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5660 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5661 @end deffn
5662 @end deffn
5663
5664 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5665 @cindex at91sam4
5666 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5667 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5668 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5669 @end deffn
5670
5671 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5672 @cindex at91sam4l
5673 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5674 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5675 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5676
5677 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5678 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5679 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5680 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5681 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5682 @end deffn
5683 @end deffn
5684
5685 @anchor{atsame5}
5686 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
5687 @cindex atsame5
5688 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
5689 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
5690 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5691
5692 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
5693 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
5694 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
5695
5696 @example
5697 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5698 @end example
5699
5700 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
5701 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
5702 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5703 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
5704 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
5705 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5706
5707 @example
5708 atsame5 bootloader
5709 atsame5 bootloader 16384
5710 @end example
5711 @end deffn
5712
5713 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
5714 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5715 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5716 processor to be halted.
5717 @end deffn
5718
5719 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
5720 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5721 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5722 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5723 @end deffn
5724
5725 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
5726 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
5727 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
5728 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
5729 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5730 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
5731 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
5732 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
5733
5734 @example
5735 # Read
5736 >atsame5 userpage
5737 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5738 # Write
5739 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
5740 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other bits unchanged
5741 # (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192 bytes)
5742 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
5743 @end example
5744 @end deffn
5745
5746 @end deffn
5747
5748 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5749 @cindex atsamv
5750 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
5751 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5752 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5753 @end deffn
5754
5755 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5756 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5757 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5758 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5759 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5760
5761 @example
5762 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5763 @end example
5764
5765 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5766 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5767
5768 @itemize
5769 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5770 @item @var{banks}
5771 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5772 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5773 @item @var{pages_size}
5774 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5775 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5776 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5777 @end itemize
5778
5779 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5780 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5781 will be autoconfigured.
5782 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5783
5784 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5785 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5786 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5787 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5788 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5789
5790 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5791 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5792 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5793 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5794 are not truly general purpose).
5795 @quotation Note
5796 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5797 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5798 @end quotation
5799 @end deffn
5800 @end deffn
5801
5802 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5803 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5804 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5805 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5806 @end deffn
5807
5808 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5809 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5810 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5811 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5812
5813 @example
5814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5815 @end example
5816
5817 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5818 each single sector one by one.
5819
5820 @example
5821 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5822 @end example
5823
5824 @example
5825 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5826 @end example
5827
5828 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5829 @end deffn
5830
5831 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5832 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5833 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5834 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5835 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
5836 starts at address 0.
5837
5838 @example
5839 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5840 @end example
5841 @end deffn
5842
5843 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5844 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5845 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5846 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5847 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5848 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5849 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5850 and programming the serial flash.
5851
5852 @example
5853 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5854 @end example
5855 @end deffn
5856
5857 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5858 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5859 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5860 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5861 autoconfigures itself.
5862 @example
5863 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5864 @end example
5865 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5866 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5867 this via the following command:
5868 @example
5869 efm32 debuglock num
5870 @end example
5871 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5872 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5873 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5874 supported.}
5875 @end deffn
5876
5877 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5878 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5879 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5880 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5881 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5882 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5883
5884 @example
5885 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
5886 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5887 @end example
5888
5889 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
5890 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5891 @end deffn
5892
5893 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
5894 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
5895 is an uncommon operation.}
5896 @end deffn
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5900 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5901 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5902 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5903 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5904 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5905 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5906
5907 @example
5908 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5909 @end example
5910 @end deffn
5911
5912 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5913 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5914 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5915 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5916 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5917 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5918 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5919 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5920 characters) ignored.
5921
5922 @example
5923 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5924 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5925 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5926 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5927 @end example
5928 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5929 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5930 @end deffn
5931
5932 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5933 @cindex kinetis
5934 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5935 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5936 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5937 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5938 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5939 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5940
5941 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5942 @itemize
5943 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5944 @end itemize
5945
5946 @example
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5948 @end example
5949
5950 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5951 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5952 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5953 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5954 @end deffn
5955
5956 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5957 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5958 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5959 set by 'flash protect' command.
5960 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5961 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5962 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5963 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5964 with the rest of a flash image.
5965 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5966 @end deffn
5967
5968 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5969 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5970 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5971 @end deffn
5972
5973 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5974 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5975 @end deffn
5976
5977 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5978 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5979 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5980 @end deffn
5981
5982 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5983 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5984 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5985 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5986 command completes.
5987 @end deffn
5988
5989 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5990 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5991 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5992 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5993 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5994
5995 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5996 Program Partition command.
5997
5998 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5999 Reset the device after partition setting.
6000
6001 Show partition size:
6002 @example
6003 kinetis nvm_partition info
6004 @end example
6005
6006 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6007 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6008 @example
6009 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6010 @end example
6011
6012 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6013 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6014 @example
6015 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6016 @end example
6017 @end deffn
6018
6019 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6020 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6021 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6022 @end deffn
6023
6024 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6025 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6026 Command disables watchdog timer.
6027 @end deffn
6028 @end deffn
6029
6030 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6031 @cindex kinetis_ke
6032 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6033 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6034 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6035 autoconfigures itself.
6036 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6037
6038 @example
6039 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6040 @end example
6041
6042 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6043 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6044 @end deffn
6045
6046 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6047 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6048 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6049 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6050 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6054 Command disables watchdog timer.
6055 @end deffn
6056 @end deffn
6057
6058 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6059 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6060 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6061 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6062 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6063
6064 @quotation Note
6065 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6066 driver:
6067 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6068 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6069 @end quotation
6070
6071 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6072 which must appear in the following order:
6073
6074 @itemize
6075 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6076 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6077 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6078 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6079 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6080 LPC43x[2357])
6081 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6082 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6083 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6084 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6085 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6086 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6087 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6088 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6089 at which the core is running
6090 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6091 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6092 @quotation Note
6093 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6094 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6095 However, if you do provide it,
6096 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6097 @end quotation
6098 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6099 ROM IAP entry point.
6100 @end itemize
6101
6102 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6103
6104 @example
6105 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6106 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6107 @end example
6108
6109 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6110 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6111 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6112 @end deffn
6113 @end deffn
6114
6115 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6116 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6117 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6118 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6119 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6120 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6121
6122 @example
6123 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6124 @end example
6125 @end deffn
6126
6127 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6128 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6129 from NXP.
6130
6131 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6132 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6133 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6134 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6135 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6136 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6137 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6138 you start the PLL.
6139
6140 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6141
6142 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6143 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6144 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6145
6146 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6147 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6148 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6149 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6150 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6151 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6152 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6153
6154 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6155 @example
6156 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6157 @end example
6158
6159 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6160 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6161 @code{flash banks} command.
6162
6163 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6164 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6165 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6166 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6167 a known signature.
6168 Example:
6169 @example
6170 lpc2900 signature 0
6171 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6172 @end example
6173 @end deffn
6174
6175 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6176 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6177 saves it to a file in binary format.
6178 Example:
6179 @example
6180 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6181 @end example
6182 @end deffn
6183
6184 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6185 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6186 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6187 command:
6188
6189 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6190 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6191 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6192 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6193
6194 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6195 Example:
6196 @example
6197 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6198 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6199 @end example
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6203 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6204 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6205 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6206 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6207 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6208 912 bytes.
6209 @quotation Attention
6210 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6211 @end quotation
6212 Example:
6213 @example
6214 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6215 @end example
6216 @end deffn
6217
6218 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6219 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6220 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6221 after the next power cycle.
6222 @quotation Attention
6223 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6224 @end quotation
6225 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6226 Example:
6227 @example
6228 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6229 flash info 0
6230 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6231 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6232 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6233 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6234 @end example
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6238 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6239 effective after the next power cycle.
6240 @quotation Attention
6241 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6242 @end quotation
6243 Examples:
6244 @example
6245 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6246 @end example
6247 @end deffn
6248 @end deffn
6249
6250 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6251 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6252 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6253 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6254
6255 @example
6256 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6257 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6258 @end example
6259
6260 @itemize @bullet
6261 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6262 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6263 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6264 @end itemize
6265
6266 Example usage:
6267 @example
6268 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6269 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6270 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6271 @} else @{
6272 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6273 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6274 @}
6275 @end example
6276 @end deffn
6277
6278 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6279 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6280 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6281 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6282 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6283 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6284
6285 @example
6286 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6287 @end example
6288
6289 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6290 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6291 only the main program flash.
6292
6293 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6294 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6295 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6299 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6300 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6301 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6302
6303 To erase and program the BSL:
6304 @example
6305 msp432 bsl unlock
6306 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6307 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6308 msp432 bsl lock
6309 @end example
6310 @end deffn
6311 @end deffn
6312
6313 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6314 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6315 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6316 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6317 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6318 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6319 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6320 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6321 also have division into regions: main and info.
6322 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6323 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6324
6325 @example
6326 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6327 @end example
6328
6329 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6330
6331 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6332 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6333 @end deffn
6334
6335 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6336 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6337 @end deffn
6338
6339 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6340 Erase all userflash including info region.
6341 @end deffn
6342
6343 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6344 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6345 @end deffn
6346
6347 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6348 Check sectors protect.
6349 @end deffn
6350
6351 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6352 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6353 @end deffn
6354
6355 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6356 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6357 @end deffn
6358
6359 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6360 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6361 @end deffn
6362
6363 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6364 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6365 @end deffn
6366
6367 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6368 Show information about flash driver.
6369 @end deffn
6370
6371 @end deffn
6372
6373 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6374 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6375 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6376 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6377 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6378
6379 @example
6380 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6381 @end example
6382
6383 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6384
6385 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6386 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6387 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6388 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6389 code.
6390 @end deffn
6391
6392 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6393 Decodes and shows informations from FICR and UICR registers.
6394 @end deffn
6395
6396 @end deffn
6397
6398 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6399 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6400 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6401
6402 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6403 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6404 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6405 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6406
6407 @example
6408 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6409 @end example
6410 @end deffn
6411
6412 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6413 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6414 and integrate flash memory.
6415
6416 @example
6417 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6418 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6419 @end example
6420
6421 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6422 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6423 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6424 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6425 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6426 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6427 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6428 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6429 @end deffn
6430 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6431 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6432 This will remove any Code Protection.
6433 @end deffn
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6437 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6438 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6439 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6440 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6441
6442 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6443 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6444
6445 @example
6446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6447 @end example
6448
6449 psoc4-specific commands
6450 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6451 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6452
6453 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6454 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6455
6456 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6457 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6458 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6459
6460 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6461 @end deffn
6462
6463 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6464 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6465
6466 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6467 @end deffn
6468 @end deffn
6469
6470 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6471 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6472 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6473 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6474 apart from the base address.
6475
6476 @example
6477 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6478 @end example
6479
6480 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6481 @quotation Attention
6482 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6483 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6484 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6485 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6486 @end quotation
6487
6488 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6489
6490 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6491 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6492 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6493 @end deffn
6494 @end deffn
6495
6496 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6497 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6498 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6499 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6500 apart from the base address.
6501
6502 @example
6503 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6504 @end example
6505 @end deffn
6506
6507 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6508 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6509 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6510 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6511
6512 @example
6513 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6514 @end example
6515
6516 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6517
6518 @itemize
6519 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6520 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6521 @end itemize
6522
6523 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6524
6525 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6526 @quotation Attention
6527 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6528 after successful write.
6529 @end quotation
6530 @end deffn
6531
6532 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6533 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6534 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6535 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6536
6537 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6538 @itemize @bullet
6539 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6540 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6541 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6542 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6543 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6544 row size: 512 bytes.
6545 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6546 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6547 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6548 operation will erase row automatically.
6549 @end itemize
6550
6551 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6552 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6553
6554 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6555
6556 @example
6557 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6558 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6559 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6560 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6561 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6562 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6563
6564 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6565 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6566 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6567 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6568 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6569 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6570 @end example
6571
6572 psoc6-specific commands
6573 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6574 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6575 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6576 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6577 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6578 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6579 @end deffn
6580
6581 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6582 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6583 by @command{flash banks}.
6584 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6585 @end deffn
6586 @end deffn
6587
6588 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6589 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6590 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6591 and SWD interface.
6592 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6593 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6594
6595 @example
6596 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6597 @end example
6598
6599 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6600
6601 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6602 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6603 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6604 @end deffn
6605
6606 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6607 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6608 @end deffn
6609 @end deffn
6610
6611 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6612 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6613 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6614 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6615 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6616
6617 @example
6618 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6619 @end example
6620
6621 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6622 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6623 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6624 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6625 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6626 disabled.
6627
6628 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6629 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6630 @quotation Warning
6631 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6632 applied to all of them.
6633 @end quotation
6634 @end deffn
6635 @end deffn
6636
6637 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6638 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6639 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6640 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6641 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6642
6643 @example
6644 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6645 @end example
6646
6647 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6648 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6649 the flash driver.
6650
6651 @example
6652 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6653 @end example
6654
6655 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6656 as per the following example.
6657 @example
6658 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6659 @end example
6660
6661 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6662
6663 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6664 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
6665 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6666 @end deffn
6667
6668 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6669 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
6670 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
6671 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6672 @end deffn
6673
6674 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6675 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
6676 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6677 @end deffn
6678
6679 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6680 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
6681 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
6682 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
6686 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6687 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6688 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
6689 @end deffn
6690
6691 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
6692 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
6693 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
6694 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
6695 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6696 @end deffn
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6700 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6701 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6702 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6703 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6704
6705 @example
6706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6707 @end example
6708
6709 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
6710 as per the following example.
6711 @example
6712 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6713 @end example
6714
6715 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
6716 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
6717 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6718 @end deffn
6719
6720 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6721 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6722 the flash driver.
6723
6724 @example
6725 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6726 @end example
6727
6728 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6729
6730 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6731 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6732 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6733 @end deffn
6734
6735 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6736 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6737 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6738 @end deffn
6739
6740 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6741 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6742 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6743 @end deffn
6744
6745 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6746 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6747 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6748 @end deffn
6749
6750 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6751 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6752 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6753 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6754 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6755 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6759 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6760 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6761 @end deffn
6762 @end deffn
6763
6764 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6765 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6766 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6767 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6768 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6769
6770 @example
6771 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6772 @end example
6773
6774 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6775 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6776 the flash driver.
6777
6778 @example
6779 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6780 @end example
6781
6782 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6783
6784 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6785 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6786 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6790 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6791 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6792 @end deffn
6793
6794 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6795 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6796 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6797 @end deffn
6798
6799 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
6800 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
6801 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6802 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
6803 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
6804
6805 Example usage:
6806 @example
6807 # read OPTSR_CUR
6808 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
6809 # read WPSN_CUR1R
6810 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
6811 # read WPSN_CUR2R
6812 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
6813 @end example
6814 @end deffn
6815
6816 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
6817 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
6818 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6819 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
6820 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
6821 will be touched).
6822
6823 Example usage:
6824 @example
6825 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices, by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
6826 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
6827 @end example
6828 @end deffn
6829 @end deffn
6830
6831 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6832 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6833 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6834 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6835 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6836
6837 @example
6838 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6839 @end example
6840
6841 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6842 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6843 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6844 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6845 second bank.
6846
6847 @example
6848 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6849 @end example
6850
6851 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6852
6853 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6854 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6855 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6856 @end deffn
6857
6858 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6859 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6860 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6861 @end deffn
6862
6863 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6864 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6865 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6866 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6867 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6868 @end deffn
6869 @end deffn
6870
6871 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6872 All members of the STM32L4 and STM32WB microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
6873 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6874 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6875 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6876
6877 @example
6878 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6879 @end example
6880
6881 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6882 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6883 the flash driver.
6884
6885 @example
6886 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6887 @end example
6888
6889 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6890
6891 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6892 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6893 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6894 @end deffn
6895
6896 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6897 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6898 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6899 @end deffn
6900
6901 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6902 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6903 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6904 @end deffn
6905
6906 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6907 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6908 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6909 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6910
6911 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6912 @example
6913 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6914 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6915 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
6916 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
6917 @end example
6918
6919 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6920 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6921 @end deffn
6922
6923 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6924 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6925 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6926 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6927 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6928
6929 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6930 @example
6931 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6932 @end example
6933
6934 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6935 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6936 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6937 @end deffn
6938
6939 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6940 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6941 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6942 @end deffn
6943 @end deffn
6944
6945 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6946 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6947 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6948 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6949 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6950
6951 @example
6952 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6953 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6954 @end example
6955
6956 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6957 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6958 for the specified flash bank.
6959 @end deffn
6960 @end deffn
6961
6962 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6963 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
6964 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6965 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6966 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6967
6968 @example
6969 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6970 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6971 @end example
6972
6973 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6974 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6975 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6976
6977 @itemize @bullet
6978 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6979 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6980 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6981 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6982 @end itemize
6983 @end deffn
6984
6985 @end deffn
6986
6987 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6988 @cindex str9xpec
6989
6990 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6991 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6992 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6993 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6994
6995 Here is some background info to help
6996 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6997 the str9:
6998 @enumerate
6999 @item
7000 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7001 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7002 @item
7003 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7004 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7005 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7006 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7007 @end enumerate
7008
7009 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7010 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7011 configured for flash bank 0.
7012 @example
7013 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7014 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7015 adapter assert srst
7016 # turn off target polling
7017 poll off
7018 # disable str9 core
7019 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7020 # read option bytes
7021 str9xpec options_read 0
7022 # re-enable str9 core
7023 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7024 poll on
7025 reset halt
7026 @end example
7027 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7028 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7029 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7030 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7031
7032 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7033
7034 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7035 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7036 @end deffn
7037
7038 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7039 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7040 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7041 @end deffn
7042
7043 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7044 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7045 erase the device.
7046 @end deffn
7047
7048 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7049 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7050 @end deffn
7051
7052 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7053 Configure str9 boot bank.
7054 @end deffn
7055
7056 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7057 Configure str9 lvd source.
7058 @end deffn
7059
7060 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7061 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7062 @end deffn
7063
7064 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7065 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7066 @end deffn
7067
7068 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7069 Read str9 option bytes.
7070 @end deffn
7071
7072 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7073 Write str9 option bytes.
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7077 unlock str9 device.
7078 @end deffn
7079
7080 @end deffn
7081
7082 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7083 @cindex swm050
7084 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7085
7086 @example
7087 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7088 @end example
7089
7090 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7091
7092 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7093 Erases the entire flash bank.
7094 @end deffn
7095
7096 @end deffn
7097
7098
7099 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7100 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7101 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7102 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7103
7104 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7105
7106 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7107 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7108 @end deffn
7109
7110 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7111 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7112 @end deffn
7113
7114 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7115 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7116 the flash clock.
7117 @end deffn
7118 @end deffn
7119
7120 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7121 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7122 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7123 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7124 correct bank config.
7125
7126 @example
7127 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7128 @end example
7129 @end deffn
7130
7131 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7132 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7133 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7134 @end deffn
7135
7136 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7137 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7138 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7139
7140 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7141
7142 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7143 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7144 @end deffn
7145
7146 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7147 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7148 @end deffn
7149
7150 @end deffn
7151
7152 @section NAND Flash Commands
7153 @cindex NAND
7154
7155 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7156 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7157 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7158
7159 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7160 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7161 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7162 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7163 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7164 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7165
7166 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7167 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7168 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7169 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7170 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7171 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7172 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7173 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7174 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7175 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7176
7177 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7178 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7179 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7180 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7181 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7182 every 512 bytes of data.
7183
7184 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7185 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7186 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7187 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7188 ECC mode is used.
7189
7190 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7191 @enumerate
7192 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7193 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7194 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7195 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7196 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7197 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7198 to access that device.
7199 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7200 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7201 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7202 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7203 de-brick a board.
7204 @end enumerate
7205
7206 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7207 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7208 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7209 are only 32 bits wide.
7210 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7211 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7212 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7213 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7214
7215 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7216 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7217 @cindex NAND configuration
7218
7219 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7220 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7221 OpenOCD has initialized.
7222
7223 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7224 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7225 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7226 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7227 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7228 they were a single (larger) device.
7229 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7230 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7231
7232 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7233 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7234 configuration files, not interactively.
7235
7236 @itemize @bullet
7237 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7238 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7239 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7240 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7241 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7242 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7243 commands to the NAND controller.
7244 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7245 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7246 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7247 for more information.
7248 @end itemize
7249 @end deffn
7250
7251 @deffn Command {nand list}
7252 Prints a summary of each device declared
7253 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7254 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7255 @example
7256 > nand list
7257 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7258 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7259 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7260 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7261 >
7262 @end example
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7266 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7267 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7268 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7269 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7270 it with most other NAND commands.
7271 @end deffn
7272
7273 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7274
7275 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7276 @cindex NAND reading
7277 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7278 starting at the specified offset.
7279 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7280
7281 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7282 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7283
7284 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7285 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7286 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7287
7288 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7289 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7290 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7291 method which handled that error correction.
7292
7293 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7294 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7295 @itemize @bullet
7296 @item no oob_* parameter
7297 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7298 @item @code{oob_raw}
7299 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7300 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7301 spare areas associated with each data page.
7302 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7303 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7304 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7305 @item @code{oob_only}
7306 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7307 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7308 spare areas associated with each data page.
7309 @end itemize
7310 @end deffn
7311
7312 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7313 @cindex NAND erasing
7314 @cindex NAND programming
7315 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7316 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7317 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7318 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7319 If those parameters are not specified,
7320 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7321 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7322
7323 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7324 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7325 block marker.
7326 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7327 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7328 @end deffn
7329
7330 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7331 @cindex NAND writing
7332 @cindex NAND programming
7333 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7334 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7335 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7336 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7337
7338 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7339 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7340
7341 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7342 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7343 past the end of the device.
7344 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7345 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7346 if that's being written.)
7347
7348 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7349 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7350 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7351
7352 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7353 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7354 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7355 @itemize @bullet
7356 @item no oob_* parameter
7357 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7358 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7359 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7360 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7361 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7362 @item @code{oob_only}
7363 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7364 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7365 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7366 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7367 @item @code{oob_raw}
7368 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7369 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7370 un-altered OOB.
7371 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7372 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7373 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7374 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7375 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7376 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7377 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7378 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7379 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7380 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7381 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7382 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7383 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7384 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7385 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7386 @end itemize
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7390 @cindex NAND verification
7391 @cindex NAND programming
7392 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7393 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7394 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7395
7396 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7397 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7398
7399 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7400 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7401 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7402 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7403 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7404
7405 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7406 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7407 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7408
7409 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7410 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7411 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7412 be removed in a future release.
7413 @end deffn
7414
7415 @subsection Other NAND commands
7416 @cindex NAND other commands
7417
7418 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7419 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7420 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7421 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7422 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7423 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7424 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7425 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7426
7427 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7428 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7429 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7430 @end deffn
7431
7432 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7433 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7434 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7435 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7436 status for each block.
7437 @end deffn
7438
7439 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7440 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7441 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7442
7443 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7444 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7445 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7446 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7447 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7448
7449 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7450 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7451 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7452 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7453 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7454 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7455 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7456 @end deffn
7457
7458 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7459 @subsection NAND Driver List
7460 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7461 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7462 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7463
7464 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7465 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7466 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7467 address of the ECC controller.
7468 @example
7469 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7470 @end example
7471 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7472 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7473 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7474 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7475 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7476 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7477 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7478 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7479 @end deffn
7480 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7481 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7482 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7483 @end deffn
7484
7485 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7486 properly configured for input or output.
7487 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7488 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7489 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7490 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7491 @end deffn
7492 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7493 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7494 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7495 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7496 @end deffn
7497 @end deffn
7498
7499 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7500 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7501 chips from Texas Instruments.
7502 It takes three extra parameters:
7503 address of the NAND chip;
7504 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7505 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7506 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7507 @example
7508 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7509 @end example
7510 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7511 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7512 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7513 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7514 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7518 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7519 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7520 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7521 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7522 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7523 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7527 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7528 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7529 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7530 @end deffn
7531 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7532
7533 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7534 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7535 should work for this chip as well.
7536 @end deffn
7537
7538 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7539 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7540 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7541 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7542 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7543 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7544 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7545 @example
7546 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7547 @end example
7548 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7549 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7550 without parameter query status.
7551 @end deffn
7552 @end deffn
7553
7554 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7555 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7556 parameter: the address of the controller.
7557 @example
7558 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7559 @end example
7560 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7561 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7562 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7563 change any behavior.
7564 @end deffn
7565
7566 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7567 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7568 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7569 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7570 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7571 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7572 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7573 specialized commands.
7574 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7575 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7576 change any behavior.
7577 @end deffn
7578
7579 @node Flash Programming
7580 @chapter Flash Programming
7581
7582 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7583 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7584 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7585
7586 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7587 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7588
7589 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7590 @enumerate
7591 @item 'init' is executed.
7592 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7593 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7594 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7595 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7596 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7597 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7598 @end enumerate
7599
7600 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7601
7602 @example
7603 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7604 # are optional parameters
7605 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7606 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7607
7608 # binary files need the flash address passing
7609 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7610 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7611 @end example
7612
7613 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7614 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7615 @cindex PLD
7616 @cindex FPGA
7617
7618 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7619 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7620 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7621 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7622 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7623 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7624 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7625
7626 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7627
7628 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7629 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7630 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7631
7632 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7633 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7634
7635 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7636 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7637 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7638 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7639 behavior.
7640 @end deffn
7641
7642 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7643 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7644 @end deffn
7645
7646 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7647 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7648 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7649 @end deffn
7650
7651 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7652
7653 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7654 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7655 that particular type of PLD.
7656
7657 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7658 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7659 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7660
7661 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7662 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7663 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7664
7665 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7666 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7667 for FPGA @var{num}.
7668 @end deffn
7669 @end deffn
7670
7671 @node General Commands
7672 @chapter General Commands
7673 @cindex commands
7674
7675 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7676 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7677 commands are documented elsewhere.
7678
7679 Intent:
7680 @itemize @bullet
7681 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7682 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7683 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7684 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7685
7686 @item @b{From the human}
7687 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7688 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7689
7690 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7691 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7692 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7693
7694 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7695 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7696 port is 5555.
7697 @end itemize
7698
7699
7700 @section Server Commands
7701
7702 @deffn {Command} exit
7703 Exits the current telnet session.
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7707 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7708 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7709 Not every command provides helptext.
7710
7711 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7712 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7713 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7714 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7715 @end deffn
7716
7717 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7718 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7719 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7720 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7721 Useful in connection with script files
7722 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7723 @end deffn
7724
7725 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7726 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7727 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7728 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7729
7730 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7731 @example
7732 # redefine shutdown
7733 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7734 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7735 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7736 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7737 original_shutdown
7738 @}
7739 @end example
7740 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7741 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7742 @end deffn
7743
7744 @anchor{debuglevel}
7745 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7746 @cindex message level
7747 Display debug level.
7748 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7749 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7750 Level 0 is error messages only;
7751 level 1 adds warnings;
7752 level 2 adds informational messages;
7753 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7754 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7755 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7756 the command line along with the location of that log
7757 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7758 @xref{Running}.
7759 @end deffn
7760
7761 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7762 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7763 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7764 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7765 @example
7766 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7767 @end example
7768 @end deffn
7769
7770 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7771 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7772 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7773 @end deffn
7774
7775 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7776 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7777 @end deffn
7778
7779 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7780 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7781 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7782 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7783 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7784 @end deffn
7785
7786 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7787 @section Target State handling
7788 @cindex reset
7789 @cindex halt
7790 @cindex target initialization
7791
7792 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7793 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7794 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7795 a current target which is used to perform the
7796 various operations. The current target may be changed
7797 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7798 target which should become current.
7799
7800 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7801 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7802 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7803 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7804 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7805
7806 @emph{With no arguments}:
7807 list all available registers for the current target,
7808 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7809 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7810 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7811 are flagged as such.
7812
7813 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7814 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7815 bypassing any internal cache.
7816
7817 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7818 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7819 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7820 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7821 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7822 relevant module will flush such values.
7823
7824 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7825 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7826
7827 @example
7828 > reg
7829 ===== ARM registers
7830 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7831 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7832 (2) r2 (/32)
7833 ...
7834 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7835 >
7836 @end example
7837 @end deffn
7838
7839 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7840 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7841 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7842 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7843 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7844 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7845 (and enter debug mode).
7846 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7847
7848 @quotation Warning
7849 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7850 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7851 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7852 power mode by gating the core clock;
7853 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7854
7855 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7856 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7857 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7858 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7859 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7860 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7861
7862 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7863 work with a JTAG debugger.
7864 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7865 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7866 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7867 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7868 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7869 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7870 @end quotation
7871
7872 @end deffn
7873
7874 @deffn Command resume [address]
7875 Resume the target at its current code position,
7876 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7877 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn Command step [address]
7881 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7882 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7883 @end deffn
7884
7885 @anchor{resetcommand}
7886 @deffn Command reset
7887 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7888 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7889 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7890 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7891 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7892 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7893
7894 The optional parameter specifies what should
7895 happen after the reset.
7896 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7897 The other options will not work on all systems.
7898 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7899
7900 @itemize @minus
7901 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7902 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7903 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7904 @end itemize
7905 @end deffn
7906
7907 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7908 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7909 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7910 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7911 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7912 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7913 state.
7914 @end deffn
7915
7916 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7917 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
7918 Set values of reset signals.
7919 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
7920 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
7921 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
7922 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
7923
7924 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
7925 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
7926 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
7927 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7928 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
7929 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
7930 the signal will not be modified.
7931
7932 @quotation Note
7933 TRST is specially handled.
7934 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
7935 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
7936 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
7937 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
7938 instead of the TRST signal.
7939 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
7940 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
7941 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
7942 with handlers for that event.
7943 @end quotation
7944 @end deffn
7945
7946 @section I/O Utilities
7947
7948 These commands are available when
7949 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7950 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7951 notably the ZY1000.
7952 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7953
7954 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7955
7956 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7957 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7958 the text file @file{filename}.
7959 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7960 The last string is followed by a newline.
7961 @end deffn
7962
7963 @deffn Command cat filename
7964 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7965 @end deffn
7966
7967 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7968 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7969 into @file{dest_filename}.
7970 @end deffn
7971
7972 @deffn Command ip
7973 @emph{No description provided.}
7974 @end deffn
7975
7976 @deffn Command ls
7977 @emph{No description provided.}
7978 @end deffn
7979
7980 @deffn Command mac
7981 @emph{No description provided.}
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn Command meminfo
7985 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7986 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7987 @end deffn
7988
7989 @deffn Command peek
7990 @emph{No description provided.}
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @deffn Command poke
7994 @emph{No description provided.}
7995 @end deffn
7996
7997 @deffn Command rm filename
7998 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7999 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8000 @end deffn
8001
8002 @deffn Command trunc filename
8003 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8004 @end deffn
8005
8006 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8007 @section Memory access commands
8008 @cindex memory access
8009
8010 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8011 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8012 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8013 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8014
8015 @enumerate
8016 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8017 to change the current target.
8018 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8019 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8020 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8021 @end enumerate
8022
8023 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8024 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8025 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8026 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8027 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8028 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8029 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8030 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8031 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8032 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8033 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8034 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8035 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8036 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8037 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8038 @end deffn
8039
8040 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8041 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8042 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8043 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8044 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8045 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8046 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8047 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8048 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8049 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8050 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8051 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8052 @end deffn
8053
8054 @anchor{imageaccess}
8055 @section Image loading commands
8056 @cindex image loading
8057 @cindex image dumping
8058
8059 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8060 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8061 binary file named @var{filename}.
8062 @end deffn
8063
8064 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8065 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8066 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8067 @end deffn
8068
8069 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8070 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8071 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8072 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8073 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8074 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8075 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8076 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8077 separately.
8078 @end deffn
8079
8080 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8081 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8082 The file format may optionally be specified
8083 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8084 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8085 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8086 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8087 @example
8088 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8089 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8090 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8091 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8092 $address $length
8093 @}
8094 @end example
8095 @end deffn
8096
8097 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8098 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8099 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8100 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8101 The file format may optionally be specified
8102 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8103 @end deffn
8104
8105 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8106 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8107 The file format may optionally be specified
8108 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8109 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8110 @end deffn
8111
8112 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8113 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8114 The file format may optionally be specified
8115 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8116 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8117 @end deffn
8118
8119
8120 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8121 @cindex breakpoint
8122 @cindex watchpoint
8123
8124 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8125 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8126 watchpoints.
8127 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8128
8129 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8130 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8131 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8132 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8133 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8134 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8135
8136 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8137 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8138 @end deffn
8139
8140 @deffn Command {rbp} address
8141 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
8142 @end deffn
8143
8144 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8145 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8146 @end deffn
8147
8148 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8149 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8150 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8151 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8152 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8153 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8154 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8155 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8156 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8157 @end deffn
8158
8159 @section Misc Commands
8160
8161 @cindex profiling
8162 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8163 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8164 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8165 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8166 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8167 limit the address range.
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {version}
8171 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8172 @end deffn
8173
8174 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8175 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8176 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8177 @end deffn
8178
8179 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8180 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8181 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8182 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8183
8184 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8185 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8186 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8187 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8188
8189 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8190 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8191 @cindex tracing
8192 @cindex ETM
8193 @cindex ETB
8194
8195 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8196 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8197 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8198
8199 @itemize
8200 @item
8201 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8202 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8203 supports such an interface.
8204 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8205 and trace port support.)
8206 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8207 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8208 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8209 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8210 in the board-specific configuration file.
8211 @item
8212 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8213 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8214 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8215 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8216 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8217 @end itemize
8218
8219 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8220
8221 @quotation Issues
8222 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8223 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8224
8225 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8226 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8227 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8228 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8229 dummy trace port driver}.
8230
8231 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8232 as well as tracing only during specific states
8233 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8234
8235 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8236 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8237 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8238 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8239 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8240
8241 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8242 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8243 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8244 this original style of JTAG access.
8245 @end quotation
8246
8247 @subsection ETM Configuration
8248 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8249
8250 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8251 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8252 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8253
8254 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8255 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8256 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8257 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8258 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8259 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8260 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8261 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8262 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8263
8264 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8265 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8266 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8267
8268 @quotation Warning
8269 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8270 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8271 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8272 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8273 @end quotation
8274
8275 @quotation Note
8276 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8277 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8278 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8279 what CPU activities are traced.
8280 @end quotation
8281 @end deffn
8282
8283 @deffn Command {etm info}
8284 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8285 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8286 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8287 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8288 @end deffn
8289
8290 @deffn Command {etm status}
8291 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8292 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8293 Did trace data overflow?
8294 Was it triggered?
8295 @end deffn
8296
8297 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8298 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8299 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8300 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8301 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8302
8303 @itemize
8304 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8305 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8306 The value is one of
8307 @option{none} (save nothing),
8308 @option{data} (save data),
8309 @option{address} (save addresses),
8310 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8311 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8312 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8313 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8314 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8315 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8316 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8317 trace stream without an image of the code.
8318 @end itemize
8319 @end deffn
8320
8321 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8322 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8323 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8324 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8325 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8326
8327 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8328 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8329 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8330 @end deffn
8331
8332 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8333
8334 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8335 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8336 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8337
8338 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8339 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8340 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8341 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8342 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8343 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8344 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8345
8346 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8347
8348 @itemize
8349 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8350 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8351 for instruction access within that function's body.
8352 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8353 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8354 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8355 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8356 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8357 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8358 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8359 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8360 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8361 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8362 @item @emph{... more}
8363 @end itemize
8364
8365 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8366 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8367
8368 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8369 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8370 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8371 @end deffn
8372
8373 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8374 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8375 @end deffn
8376
8377 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8378 Opens an image file.
8379 @end deffn
8380
8381 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8382 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8383 @end deffn
8384
8385 @deffn Command {etm start}
8386 Starts trace data collection.
8387 @end deffn
8388
8389 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8390 Stops trace data collection.
8391 @end deffn
8392
8393 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8394 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8395
8396 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8397
8398 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8399 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8400 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8401 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8402 any trace data collection.}
8403 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8404 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8405 @end deffn
8406 @end deffn
8407
8408 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8409 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8410 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8411 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8412 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8413 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8414 @end deffn
8415 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8416 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8417 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8418 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8419 trace trigger becomes active.
8420
8421 @itemize
8422 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8423 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8424 afterwards.
8425 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8426 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8427 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8428 what caused that event to happen.
8429 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8430 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8431 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8432 how the event caused trouble.
8433 @end itemize
8434 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8435 @end deffn
8436
8437 @end deffn
8438
8439 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8440 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8441 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8442 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8443 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8444
8445 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8446 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8447
8448 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8449 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8450 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8451 @end deffn
8452
8453 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8454 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8455 @end deffn
8456
8457 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8458 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8459 @end deffn
8460 @end deffn
8461
8462 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8463 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8464 @cindex CTI
8465
8466 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8467 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8468 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8469 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8470 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8471 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8472
8473 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8474 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8475 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8476 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8477 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8478 including additional configuration.
8479 @end deffn
8480
8481 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8482 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8483 @end deffn
8484
8485 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8486 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8487 @end deffn
8488
8489 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8490 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8491 @end deffn
8492
8493 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8494 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8495 @end deffn
8496
8497 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8498 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8502 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8503 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8504 @end deffn
8505
8506 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8507 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8508 of the CTI.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @deffn Command {cti names}
8512 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8513 useful in TCL scripting.
8514 @end deffn
8515
8516 @section Generic ARM
8517 @cindex ARM
8518
8519 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8520 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8521 commands that may be available.
8522
8523 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8524 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8525 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8526 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8527 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8528 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8529 @end deffn
8530
8531 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8532 @cindex disassemble
8533 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8534 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8535 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8536 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8537 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8538 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8539 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8540
8541 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8542 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8543 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8544 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8545 with a handful of exceptions.
8546 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8547 @end deffn
8548
8549 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8550 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8551 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8552 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8553 and using the MCR instruction.
8554 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8555 an ARM register.)
8556 @end deffn
8557
8558 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8559 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8560 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8561 and the MRC instruction.
8562 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8563 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8564 an ARM register.)
8565 @end deffn
8566
8567 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8568 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8569 core mode if necessary.
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8573 @cindex ARM semihosting
8574 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8575
8576 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8577 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8578 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8579 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8580 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8581 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8582 @end deffn
8583
8584 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8585 @cindex ARM semihosting
8586 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8587
8588 @example
8589 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8590 @end example
8591
8592 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8593 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8594 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8595 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8596 @end deffn
8597
8598 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8599 @cindex ARM semihosting
8600 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8601 status.
8602
8603 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8604 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8605 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8606 debugger.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8610 @cindex ARM semihosting
8611 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8612
8613 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8614 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8615 the value returned by the target.
8616
8617 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8618 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8619 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8620 encountering a break.
8621
8622 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8623 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8624 to the debugger.
8625 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8626 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8627 request or equivalent").
8628
8629 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8630 this option (default: disabled).
8631 @end deffn
8632
8633 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8634 @cindex ARMv4
8635 @cindex ARMv5
8636
8637 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8638 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8639 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8640 variant.
8641
8642 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8643 @cindex ARM7
8644 @cindex ARM9
8645
8646 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8647 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8648 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8649 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8650
8651 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8652 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8653 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8654 instead of breakpoints.
8655 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8656
8657 This should be
8658 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8659 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8660 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8661 @end deffn
8662
8663 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8664 @cindex DCC
8665 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8666 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8667 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8668
8669 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8670 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8671 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8672 @end deffn
8673
8674 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8675 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8676 that don't check completion of the operation.
8677 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8678
8679 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8680 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8681 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8682 @end deffn
8683
8684 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8685 @cindex ARM720T
8686
8687 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8688 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8689 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8690 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8691
8692 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8693 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8694 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8695
8696 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8697 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8698 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8699 @end deffn
8700
8701 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8702 @cindex ARM9
8703
8704 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8705 integer processors.
8706 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8707
8708 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8709 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8710 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8711 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8712
8713 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8714 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8715 @cindex vector_catch
8716 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8717 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8718 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8719 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8720 to those hardware vectors.
8721
8722 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8723 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8724 vector catch hardware to intercept
8725 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8726 @option{none} of them,
8727 or a list with one or more of the following:
8728 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8729 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8730 @end deffn
8731
8732 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8733 @cindex ARM920T
8734
8735 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8736 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8737 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8738 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8739 and ARM9 commands.
8740
8741 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8742 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8743 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8744 @end deffn
8745
8746 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8747 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8748 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8749 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8750 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8751 (Not all registers can be written.)
8752 @end deffn
8753
8754 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8755 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8756 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8757
8758 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8759 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8760 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8761 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8762 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8763 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8764 @end deffn
8765
8766 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8767 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8768 @end deffn
8769
8770 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8771 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8772 @end deffn
8773
8774 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8775 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8776
8777 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8778 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8779 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8780 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8781 and ARM9 commands.
8782
8783 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8784 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8785
8786 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8787 Print information about the caches found.
8788 @end deffn
8789
8790 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8791 @cindex ARM966E
8792
8793 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8794 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8795 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8796 and ARM9 commands.
8797
8798 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8799 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8800 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8801 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8802 ARM966E-S TRM.
8803 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8804 as required for BIST support.
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @subsection XScale specific commands
8808 @cindex XScale
8809
8810 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8811
8812 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8813 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8814 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8815 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8816 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8817 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8818 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8819
8820 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8821 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8822 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8823 the mini-IC.
8824
8825 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8826 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8827 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8828 code layout in memory:
8829 @example
8830 _vectors:
8831 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8832 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8833 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8834 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8835 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8836 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8837 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8838 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8839 .org 0x100
8840 .long real_reset_vector
8841 .long real_ui_handler
8842 .long real_swi_handler
8843 .long real_pf_abort
8844 .long real_data_abort
8845 .long 0 /* unused */
8846 .long real_irq_handler
8847 .long real_fiq_handler
8848 @end example
8849
8850 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8851 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8852 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8853 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8854 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8855 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8856 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8857 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8858 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8859 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8860 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8861 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8862 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8863 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8864 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8865 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8866 software.
8867
8868 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8869 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8870 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8871 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8872
8873 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8874 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8875 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8876 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8877 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8878 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8879 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8880 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8881 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8882
8883 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8884 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8885
8886 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8887 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8888 @end deffn
8889
8890 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8891 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8892 @end deffn
8893
8894 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8895 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8896 @end deffn
8897
8898 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8899 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8900 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8901 @end deffn
8902
8903 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8904 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8905 @end deffn
8906
8907 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8908 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8909 @end deffn
8910
8911 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8912 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8913 @end deffn
8914
8915 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8916 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8917 @end deffn
8918
8919 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8920 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8924 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8925 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8926 and modifying how it is emptied.
8927 @end deffn
8928
8929 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8930 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8931 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8932 The image @var{type} may be one of
8933 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8934 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8935 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8936 @end deffn
8937
8938 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8939 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8940 @cindex vector_catch
8941 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8942 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8943
8944 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8945 @example
8946 0x01 Trap Reset
8947 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8948 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8949 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8950 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8951 0x20 reserved
8952 0x40 Trap IRQ
8953 0x80 Trap FIQ
8954 @end example
8955 @end deffn
8956
8957 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8958 @cindex vector_table
8959
8960 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8961 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8962 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8963 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8964 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8965
8966 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8967
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8971 @cindex ARMv6
8972
8973 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8974 @cindex ARM11
8975
8976 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8977 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8978 which is enabled by default.
8979 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8980 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8981 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8982 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8983 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8984 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8985 @end deffn
8986
8987 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8988 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8989 which is enabled by default.
8990 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8991 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8992 @end deffn
8993
8994 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8995 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8996 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8997 they are disabled by default.
8998 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8999 @end deffn
9000
9001 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9002 @cindex vector_catch
9003 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9004 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9005 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9006
9007 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9008 for certain hardware events.
9009 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9010 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9011 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9012 @end deffn
9013
9014 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9015 @cindex ARMv7
9016 @cindex ARMv8
9017
9018 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9019 @cindex Cortex-A
9020
9021 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9022 display information about target caches
9023 @end deffn
9024
9025 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9026 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9027 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9028 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9029 Defaults to 'off'.
9030 @end deffn
9031
9032 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9033 Initialize core debug
9034 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9035 @end deffn
9036
9037 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9038 Display/set the current SMP mode
9039 @end deffn
9040
9041 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9042 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9043 @end deffn
9044
9045 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9046 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9047 @end deffn
9048
9049 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9050 configure l2x cache
9051 @end deffn
9052
9053 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9054 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9055 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9056 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9057 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9058 @end deffn
9059
9060 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9061 @cindex Cortex-R
9062
9063 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9064 Initialize core debug
9065 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9069 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9070 @end deffn
9071
9072
9073 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9074 @cindex tracing
9075 @cindex SWO
9076 @cindex SWV
9077 @cindex TPIU
9078 @cindex ITM
9079 @cindex ETM
9080
9081 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
9082 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
9083 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
9084
9085 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
9086 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9087 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9088 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9089
9090 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
9091 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
9092 debugger adapter features.
9093
9094 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
9095 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
9096
9097 Command options:
9098 @itemize @minus
9099 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
9100 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
9101 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
9102 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9103 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
9104 either a regular file or a named pipe);
9105 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
9106 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
9107 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
9108 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
9109 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
9110 coding;
9111 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
9112 regular UART 8N1) coding;
9113 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
9114 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
9115 data is to be output via SWO;
9116 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
9117 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
9118 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
9119 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
9120 rate automatically.
9121 @end itemize
9122
9123 Example usage:
9124 @enumerate
9125 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9126 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9127 enough to:
9128 @example
9129 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9130 ...
9131 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9132 ...
9133 @end example
9134 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9135 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9136 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9137 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9138 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9139 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9140 @example
9141 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9142 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9143 @end example
9144 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9145 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9146 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9147 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9148 @example
9149 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9150 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9151 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9152 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
9153 @end example
9154 @end enumerate
9155 @end deffn
9156
9157 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9158 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9159 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9160 @end deffn
9161
9162 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9163 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9164 @end deffn
9165
9166 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9167 @cindex Cortex-M
9168
9169 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9170 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9171
9172 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9173 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9174 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9175 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9176 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9177 the step command leaves with the core running.
9178
9179 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9180 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9181 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9182 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9183
9184 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9185 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9186 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9187 does.
9188
9189 Default is @option{auto}.
9190 @end deffn
9191
9192 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9193 @cindex vector_catch
9194 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9195 for certain hardware events.
9196
9197 Parameters request interception of
9198 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9199 @option{none} of them,
9200 or one or more of the following:
9201 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9202 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9203 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9204 @option{irq_err},
9205 @option{state_err},
9206 @option{chk_err}, or
9207 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9208 @option{reset}.
9209 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9210 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9211 are mapped to HardFault.
9212 UsageFault checks for
9213 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9214 must also be explicitly enabled.
9215
9216 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9217 @end deffn
9218
9219 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9220 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9221 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9222
9223 @itemize @minus
9224 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9225 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9226 @end itemize
9227
9228 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9229 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9230 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9231 to manually reset the peripherals.
9232 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9233
9234 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9235 instead.
9236 @end deffn
9237
9238 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9239 @cindex ARMv8-A
9240 @cindex aarch64
9241
9242 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9243 Display information about target caches
9244 @end deffn
9245
9246 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9247 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9248 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9249 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9250 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9251 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9252 @end deffn
9253
9254 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9255 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9256 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9257 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9258 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9259 @end deffn
9260
9261 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9262 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9263 @option{on}.
9264 @end deffn
9265
9266 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9267 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9268 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9269 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9270 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9271 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9272 @end deffn
9273
9274 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9275
9276 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9277 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9278
9279 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9280
9281 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9282 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9283 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9284 @end deffn
9285
9286 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9287 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9288 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9289 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9290 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9294
9295 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9296 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9297 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9298 @end deffn
9299
9300 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9301
9302 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9303 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9304 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9305 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9306 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9307 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9308 can be collected.
9309
9310 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9311 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9312 tooling.
9313
9314 @quotation Issues
9315 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9316 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9317 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9318 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9319
9320 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9321 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9322 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9323 software operation on the CPU.
9324 @end quotation
9325
9326 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9327 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9328 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9329 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9330 @end deffn
9331
9332 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9333 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9334 @end deffn
9335
9336 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9337 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9338 control is disabled.
9339 @end deffn
9340
9341 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9342 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9343 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9344 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9345
9346 Supported trace formats:
9347 @itemize
9348 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9349 timing to be determined.
9350 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9351 addresses.
9352 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9353 @end itemize
9354 @end deffn
9355
9356 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9357 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9358 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9359 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9360
9361 Supported conditions:
9362 @itemize
9363 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9364 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9365 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9366 instruction matches start data and mask.
9367 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9368 instruction matches start data and mask.
9369 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9370 data and mask.
9371 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9372 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9373 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9374 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9375 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9376 @end itemize
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9380 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9381 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9382 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9383
9384 Supported conditions:
9385 @itemize
9386 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9387 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9388 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9389 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9390 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9391 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9392 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9393 data and mask.
9394 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9395 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9396 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9397 @end itemize
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9401 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9402
9403 Supported triggers:
9404 @itemize
9405 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9406 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9407 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9408 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9409 collection.
9410 @end itemize
9411 @end deffn
9412
9413 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9414
9415 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9416 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9417 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9418 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9419 @end deffn
9420
9421 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9422 Display trace configuration.
9423 @end deffn
9424
9425 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9426 Display trace collection status.
9427 @end deffn
9428
9429 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9430 Start manual trace collection.
9431 @end deffn
9432
9433 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9434 Stop manual trace collection.
9435 @end deffn
9436
9437 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9438 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9439 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9440 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9441 @option{size} options using DMA.
9442 @end deffn
9443
9444 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9445 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9446 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9447 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9448 @option{size} options using DMA.
9449 @end deffn
9450
9451 @section Intel Architecture
9452
9453 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9454 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9455 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9456 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9457 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9458 @itemize
9459 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9460 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9461 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9462 @end itemize
9463
9464 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9465 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9466 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9467
9468 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9469 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9470 @end deffn
9471
9472 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9473 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9474 @end deffn
9475
9476 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9477 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9478 @end deffn
9479
9480 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9481 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9482 @end deffn
9483
9484 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9485 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9486 @end deffn
9487
9488 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9489 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9490 @end deffn
9491
9492 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9493
9494 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9495 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9496
9497 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9498 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9499 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9500 @end deffn
9501 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9502 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9503
9504 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9505
9506 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9507 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9508 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9509 @end deffn
9510
9511 @subsection Registers commands
9512 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9513 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9514 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9515
9516 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9517
9518 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9519 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9520 and "timer" groups.
9521
9522 @emph{example:}
9523 @example
9524 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9525 @end example
9526
9527
9528 @end deffn
9529 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9530 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9531
9532 @emph{group} can be "system",
9533 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9534 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9535 @end deffn
9536
9537 @section RISC-V Architecture
9538
9539 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9540 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9541 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9542 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9543 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9544 implement version 0.11.
9545
9546 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9547
9548 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9549 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9550 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9551
9552 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9553
9554 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9555 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9556 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9557
9558 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9559 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9560 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9561 CSRs.
9562 @end deffn
9563
9564 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9565 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
9566 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
9567 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
9568 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
9569 This command must be executed before `init`.
9570 @end deffn
9571
9572 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9573 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9574 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9575 @end deffn
9576
9577 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9578 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9579 deasserted.
9580 @end deffn
9581
9582 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9583 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9584 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9585 @end deffn
9586
9587 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9588 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9589 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9590 @end deffn
9591
9592 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
9593 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
9594 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
9595 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
9596 values.
9597
9598 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
9599 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
9600 and DBUS registers, respectively.
9601 @end deffn
9602
9603 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9604
9605 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9606 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9607 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9608 @example
9609 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
9610 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9611 @end example
9612
9613 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9614 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
9615 @end deffn
9616
9617 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9618 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9619 @end deffn
9620
9621 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9622
9623 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9624 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9625
9626 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9627 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
9628 @end deffn
9629
9630 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9631 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9632 @end deffn
9633
9634 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9635 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9636 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9637 @cindex tracing
9638 @cindex libdcc
9639 @cindex DCC
9640 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9641 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9642 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9643 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9644
9645 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9646 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9647 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9648 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9649 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9650 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9651
9652 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9653 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9654 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9655 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9656 The target being debugged may
9657 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9658 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9659 each supported by a command:
9660
9661 @itemize
9662 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9663 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9664 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9665 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9666
9667 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9668 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9669 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9670
9671 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9672 and then displayed at any time.
9673 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9674
9675 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9676 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9677 @end itemize
9678
9679 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9680 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9681 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9682 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9683 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9684 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9685 does the same thing.
9686
9687 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9688 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9689 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9690 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9691 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9692
9693 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9694 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9695 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9696 @end deffn
9697
9698 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9699 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9700 in the order they triggered.
9701 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9702 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9703 history records.
9704 @end deffn
9705
9706 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9707 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9708 they have been triggered.
9709 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9710 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9711 and associates it with that identifier.
9712
9713 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9714 are not related except by this command.
9715 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9716 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9717 @end deffn
9718
9719
9720 @node JTAG Commands
9721 @chapter JTAG Commands
9722 @cindex JTAG Commands
9723 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9724 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9725 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9726 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9727 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9728
9729 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9730 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9731
9732 @itemize @bullet
9733 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9734 devices such as a CPUs.
9735 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9736 standard state machine (in parallel)
9737 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9738 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9739 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9740 while the reading previous ones.
9741 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9742 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9743 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9744 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9745 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9746 registers.
9747 @end itemize
9748
9749 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9750
9751 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9752 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9753 the order of TAP state transitions.
9754 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9755 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9756 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9757 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9758 these commands are not available.
9759
9760 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9761 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9762 that specify the entire register.
9763 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9764 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9765 The return value holds the original value of each
9766 of those fields.
9767
9768 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9769 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9770 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9771 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9772 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9773
9774 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9775 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9776
9777 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9778 in that state.
9779 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9780 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9781 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9782
9783 @quotation Warning
9784 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9785 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9786 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9787 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9788 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9789 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9790 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9791 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9792 @end quotation
9793 @end deffn
9794
9795 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9796 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9797 This may be used for performance tuning.
9798
9799 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9800 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9801 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9802 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9803 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9804 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9805 @end deffn
9806
9807 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9808 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9809 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9810 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9811 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9812 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9813
9814 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9815 in that state.
9816 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9817 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9818 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9819
9820 @quotation Note
9821 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9822 register values, unlike data register values.
9823 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9824 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9825 @end quotation
9826 @end deffn
9827
9828 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9829 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9830 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9831 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9832 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9833 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9834 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9835 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9836 The final state must also be stable.
9837 @end deffn
9838
9839 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9840 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9841 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9842 Instructions often need some time
9843 to execute before they take effect.
9844 @end deffn
9845
9846 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9847 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9848
9849 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9850 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9851 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9852 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9853 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9854 @end deffn
9855
9856 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9857 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9858 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9859 must also be enabled.
9860 Default is enabled.
9861 @end deffn
9862
9863 @section TAP state names
9864 @cindex TAP state names
9865
9866 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9867 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9868 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9869 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9870
9871 @itemize @bullet
9872 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9873 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9874 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9875 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9876 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9877 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9878 through the data register
9879 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9880 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9881 for update or more shifting
9882 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9883 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9884 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9885 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9886 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9887 through the instruction register
9888 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9889 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9890 for update or more shifting
9891 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9892 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9893 @end itemize
9894
9895 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9896 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9897 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9898 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9899
9900 @itemize @bullet
9901 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9902 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9903 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9904 may not be as expected.
9905 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9906 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9907 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9908 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9909 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9910 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9911 @end itemize
9912
9913 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9914 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9915
9916 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9917 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9918 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9919 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9920
9921 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9922 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9923 @cindex SVF
9924
9925 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9926 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9927 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9928 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9929
9930 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9931 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9932 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9933 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9934
9935 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9936 affect their semantics.
9937
9938 Command options:
9939 @itemize @minus
9940 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9941 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9942 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9943 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9944 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9945 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9946 on the real interface;
9947 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9948 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9949 errors.
9950 @end itemize
9951 @end deffn
9952
9953 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9954 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9955 @cindex XSVF
9956
9957 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9958 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9959 Xilinx devices.
9960 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9961 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9962
9963 @quotation Important
9964 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9965 @end quotation
9966
9967 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9968 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9969 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9970 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9971 that TAP.
9972 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9973 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9974 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9975 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9976 @end deffn
9977
9978 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9979 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9980 after building the software.
9981 You may find them useful:
9982
9983 @itemize
9984 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9985 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9986 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9987 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9988 @end itemize
9989
9990 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9991 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9992 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9993 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9994 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9995 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9996 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9997
9998
9999 @node Utility Commands
10000 @chapter Utility Commands
10001 @cindex Utility Commands
10002
10003 @section RAM testing
10004 @cindex RAM testing
10005
10006 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10007 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10008 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10009 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10010 hardware problems.
10011
10012 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10013 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10014 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10015 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10016
10017 Load the memory testing functions with
10018
10019 @example
10020 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10021 @end example
10022
10023 to get access to the following facilities:
10024
10025 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10026 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10027 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10028 @end deffn
10029
10030 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10031 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10032 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10033 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10034 @end deffn
10035
10036 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10037 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10038 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10039 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10040 @end deffn
10041
10042 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10043 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10044 @end deffn
10045
10046 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10047 @cindex Firmware recovery
10048
10049 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10050 devices recovery with JTAG.
10051
10052 For quickstart instructions run:
10053 @example
10054 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10055 @end example
10056
10057 @node TFTP
10058 @chapter TFTP
10059 @cindex TFTP
10060 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
10061 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
10062
10063 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
10064 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
10065 server (tftpd). For example,
10066
10067 @example
10068 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
10069 @end example
10070
10071 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
10072 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
10073
10074 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
10075 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
10076 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
10077 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
10078
10079 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10080 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10081 @cindex GDB
10082 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10083 to debug remote targets.
10084 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10085
10086 @itemize
10087 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10088 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10089 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10090 as shown in this chapter.
10091 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10092 that also will probably need to be configured.
10093 @end itemize
10094
10095 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10096 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10097 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10098 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10099 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10100 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10101
10102 @section Connecting to GDB
10103 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10104 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10105 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10106 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10107 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10108
10109 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10110
10111 @enumerate
10112 @item
10113 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10114 @example
10115 target remote localhost:3333
10116 @end example
10117 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10118
10119 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
10120 @example
10121 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10122 @end example
10123 @item
10124 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10125 @example
10126 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10127 @end example
10128 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10129 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10130 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10131 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10132 @end enumerate
10133
10134 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10135 GDB command line.
10136
10137 @section Sample GDB session startup
10138
10139 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10140 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10141 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10142 small ARM program.
10143 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10144 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10145
10146 @example
10147 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10148 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
10149 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10150 ...
10151 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10152 ...
10153 (gdb) load
10154 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10155 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10156 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10157 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10158 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10159 (gdb) continue
10160 Continuing.
10161 ...
10162 @end example
10163
10164 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10165 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10166 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10167 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10168
10169 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10170
10171 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10172 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10173 packet size and the device's memory map.
10174 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10175 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10176 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10177
10178 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10179 You may need to set those up by hand.
10180 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10181 something like:
10182
10183 @example
10184 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10185 @end example
10186
10187 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10188
10189 @example
10190 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10191 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10192 @end example
10193
10194 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10195 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10196 do not have such restrictions.
10197
10198 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10199 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10200 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10201 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10202
10203 @section Programming using GDB
10204 @cindex Programming using GDB
10205 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10206
10207 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10208 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10209 @example
10210 gdb_memory_map disable
10211 @end example
10212 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10213 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10214 working area.
10215
10216 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10217 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10218 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10219 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10220
10221 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10222 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10223
10224 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10225 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10226 @example
10227 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10228 @end example
10229
10230 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10231 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10232
10233 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10234 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10235 will be used.
10236
10237 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10238 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10239 @example
10240 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10241 @end example
10242 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10243
10244 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10245 can be used.
10246
10247 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10248 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10249 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10250
10251 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10252 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10253 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10254
10255 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10256 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10257 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10258 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10259 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10260 without any intrusion of the target process.
10261
10262 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10263 Place following command after target configuration:
10264 @example
10265 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10266 @end example
10267
10268 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10269 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10270 @example
10271 gdb_memory_map disable
10272 @end example
10273
10274 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10275 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10276 @example
10277 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10278 @end example
10279
10280 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10281 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10282
10283 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
10284 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10285 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10286 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10287
10288 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10289 previously shown varibles.
10290
10291 @section RTOS Support
10292 @cindex RTOS Support
10293 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10294
10295 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10296 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10297
10298 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10299 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10300 GDB commands.
10301
10302 @* An example setup is below:
10303
10304 @example
10305 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10306 @end example
10307
10308 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10309
10310 Currently supported rtos's include:
10311 @itemize @bullet
10312 @item @option{eCos}
10313 @item @option{ThreadX}
10314 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10315 @item @option{linux}
10316 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10317 @item @option{embKernel}
10318 @item @option{mqx}
10319 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10320 @item @option{nuttx}
10321 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10322 @end itemize
10323
10324 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10325 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10326
10327 @table @code
10328 @item eCos symbols
10329 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10330 @item ThreadX symbols
10331 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10332 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10333 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
10334 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
10335 @tex
10336 \begingroup
10337 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
10338 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10339 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10340 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10341 \par
10342 \endgroup
10343 @end tex
10344 @item linux symbols
10345 init_task.
10346 @item ChibiOS symbols
10347 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
10348 @item embKernel symbols
10349 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
10350 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
10351 @item mqx symbols
10352 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
10353 @item uC/OS-III symbols
10354 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
10355 @item nuttx symbols
10356 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
10357 @end table
10358
10359 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
10360 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
10361
10362 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
10363 along with the project:
10364
10365 @table @code
10366 @item FreeRTOS
10367 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
10368 @item uC/OS-III
10369 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
10370 @end table
10371
10372 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
10373 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
10374 @cindex SMP
10375 @cindex RTOS
10376 @cindex hwthread
10377 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
10378 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
10379 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
10380 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
10381 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
10382 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
10383 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
10384 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
10385 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
10386
10387 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
10388 @quotation Note
10389 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
10390 @end quotation
10391
10392 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
10393 @itemize @bullet
10394 @item j - smp status request
10395 @item J - smp set request
10396 @end itemize
10397
10398 OpenOCD implements :
10399 @itemize @bullet
10400 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
10401 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
10402 @option{E01} for target not smp.
10403 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
10404 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
10405 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
10406 @end itemize
10407
10408 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
10409 @itemize @bullet
10410 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
10411 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
10412 @example
10413 set $_core 1
10414 #Jc01 packet is sent
10415 print $_core
10416 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
10417 @end example
10418
10419 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
10420 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
10421
10422 @example
10423 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
10424 define toggle0
10425 maint packet Jc0
10426 continue
10427 main packet Jc-1
10428 end
10429 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
10430 define toggle1
10431 maint packet Jc1
10432 continue
10433 main packet Jc-1
10434 end
10435 @end example
10436 @end itemize
10437
10438 @node Tcl Scripting API
10439 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
10440 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
10441 @cindex Tcl scripts
10442 @section API rules
10443
10444 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
10445 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
10446 of state information as an argument to each proc.
10447
10448 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
10449 pair list and lists.
10450
10451 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
10452 list.
10453
10454 @example
10455 > set foo(me) Duane
10456 > set foo(you) Oyvind
10457 > set foo(mouse) Micky
10458 > set foo(duck) Donald
10459 @end example
10460
10461 If one does this:
10462
10463 @example
10464 > set foo
10465 @end example
10466
10467 The result is:
10468
10469 @example
10470 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
10471 @end example
10472
10473 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
10474
10475 @verbatim
10476 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
10477 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
10478 }
10479 @end verbatim
10480
10481 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10482 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10483
10484 @section Internal low-level Commands
10485
10486 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10487 invoke directly.
10488
10489 @itemize @bullet
10490 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10491
10492 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10493 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10494
10495 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10496 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10497
10498 Return information about the flash banks
10499
10500 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10501
10502 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10503 its execution. Example:
10504
10505 @example
10506 > capture "reset init"
10507 @end example
10508
10509 @end itemize
10510
10511 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10512 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10513 called "flash_banks".
10514
10515 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10516
10517 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10518 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10519 holds one of the following values:
10520
10521 @itemize @bullet
10522 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10523 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10524 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10525 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10526 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10527 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10528 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10529 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10530 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10531 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10532 @end itemize
10533
10534 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10535
10536 @quotation Note
10537 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10538 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10539 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10540 is jim, not real tcl).
10541 @end quotation
10542
10543 @section Tcl RPC server
10544 @cindex RPC
10545
10546 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10547 commands and receive the results.
10548
10549 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10550 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10551 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10552 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10553 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10554
10555 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
10556 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
10557 @command{capture} command.
10558
10559 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10560
10561 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10562 @cindex RPC Notifications
10563
10564 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10565 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10566
10567 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10568 in the following format.
10569
10570 @verbatim
10571 type target_event event [event-name]
10572 type target_state state [state-name]
10573 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10574 @end verbatim
10575
10576 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10577 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10578 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10579 Defaults to off.
10580
10581 @end deffn
10582
10583 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10584 @cindex RPC trace output
10585
10586 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10587 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10588
10589 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10590
10591 @verbatim
10592 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10593 @end verbatim
10594
10595 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10596 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10597 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10598 Defaults to off.
10599
10600 See an example application here:
10601 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10602
10603 @end deffn
10604
10605 @node FAQ
10606 @chapter FAQ
10607 @cindex faq
10608 @enumerate
10609 @anchor{faqrtck}
10610 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10611 @cindex RTCK
10612 @cindex adaptive clocking
10613 @*
10614
10615 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10616 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10617 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10618 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10619
10620 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10621 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10622 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10623 @enumerate
10624 @item
10625 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10626 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10627 @item
10628 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10629 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10630 @end enumerate
10631
10632 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10633 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10634 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10635 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10636 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10637 power).
10638
10639 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10640 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10641 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10642 ARM926 scenario).
10643 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10644 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10645 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10646
10647 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10648 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10649 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10650 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10651
10652 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10653
10654 In order to make use of this,
10655 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10656 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10657
10658 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10659 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10660 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10661 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10662 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10663
10664 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10665 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10666 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10667 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10668
10669 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10670 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10671 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10672 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10673 with a CPLD.
10674 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10675 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10676 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10677 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10678 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10679 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10680
10681 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10682
10683 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10684
10685 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10686 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10687 depending on the chips on your board.
10688 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10689 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10690 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10691
10692 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10693 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10694 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10695
10696 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10697 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10698 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10699 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10700
10701 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10702 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10703 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10704 this way.
10705
10706 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10707 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10708 clock rate.
10709 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10710 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10711 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10712
10713 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10714
10715 @example
10716 # Example: 1.234MHz
10717 adapter_khz 1234
10718 @end example
10719
10720
10721 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10722
10723 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10724 around Windows filenames.
10725
10726 @example
10727 > echo \a
10728
10729 > echo @{\a@}
10730 \a
10731 > echo "\a"
10732
10733 >
10734 @end example
10735
10736
10737 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10738
10739 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10740 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10741 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10742
10743 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10744 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10745 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10746
10747 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10748 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10749 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10750
10751 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10752
10753 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10754 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10755 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10756 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10757
10758 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10759 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10760 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10761
10762 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10763 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10764
10765 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10766 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10767 memory read caused data abort".
10768
10769 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10770 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10771 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10772 be done, feel free to add this here.
10773
10774 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10775 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10776 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10777 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10778 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10779 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10780 gracefully stops.
10781
10782 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10783 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10784 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10785
10786 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10787 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10788 bytes. Painful...
10789
10790
10791 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10792 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10793
10794 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10795 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
10796 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10797 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10798 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10799 reset, everything else should work fine.
10800
10801 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10802 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10803 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10804 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10805
10806 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10807 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10808 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10809 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10810
10811 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10812
10813 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10814 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10815 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10816
10817 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10818 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10819
10820 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10821 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10822 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10823 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10824 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10825 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10826 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10827 clock frequency?
10828
10829 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10830 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10831 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10832 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10833 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10834
10835 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10836
10837 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10838 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10839 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10840 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10841 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10842 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10843 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10844
10845 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10846
10847 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10848 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10849 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10850 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10851
10852 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10853 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10854 particular order?
10855
10856 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10857 the same order used by the hardware.
10858
10859 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10860 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10861 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10862 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10863 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10864 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10865
10866 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10867 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10868 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10869 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10870
10871 @itemize @bullet
10872 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10873 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10874 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10875 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10876 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10877 @end itemize
10878
10879 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10880
10881 @itemize @bullet
10882 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10883 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10884 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10885 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10886 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10887 @end itemize
10888
10889
10890 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10891 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10892 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10893
10894 TODO.
10895
10896 @end enumerate
10897
10898 @node Tcl Crash Course
10899 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10900 @cindex Tcl
10901
10902 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10903 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10904 how the Tcl scripts work.
10905
10906 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10907 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10908 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10909 OpenOCD.
10910
10911 @section Tcl Rule #1
10912 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10913 @enumerate
10914 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10915 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10916 @end enumerate
10917
10918 The Tcl equal is this:
10919
10920 @enumerate
10921 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10922 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10923 @end enumerate
10924
10925 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10926 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10927
10928 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10929 There is a second pair of rules.
10930 @enumerate
10931 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10932 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10933 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10934 in Tcl.
10935 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10936 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10937 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10938 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10939 @end enumerate
10940
10941 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10942 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10943 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10944 Everything is a string}
10945
10946 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10947 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10948 difference is subtle.
10949 @enumerate
10950 @item Parse Time
10951 @item Evaluation Time
10952 @end enumerate
10953
10954 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10955 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10956 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10957
10958 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10959 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10960 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10961 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10962
10963 @itemize @bullet
10964 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10965 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10966 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10967 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10968 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10969 @example
10970 # bash example
10971 X=`date`
10972 echo "The Date is: $X"
10973 # Tcl example
10974 set X [date]
10975 puts "The Date is: $X"
10976 @end example
10977 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10978 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10979 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10980 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10981 is a string}
10982 @example
10983 set x "Dinner"
10984 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10985 @end example
10986 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10987 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10988 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10989 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10990 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10991 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10992 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10993 @end itemize
10994
10995 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10996
10997 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10998
10999 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11000
11001 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11002 the normal way.
11003
11004 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11005 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11006 line is immediately executed.
11007
11008 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11009 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11010
11011 @subsection Command Execution
11012
11013 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11014 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11015 control flow operators.
11016
11017 Commands are executed like this:
11018
11019 @enumerate
11020 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11021 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11022 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11023 @end enumerate
11024
11025 It sort of works like this:
11026 @example
11027 for(;;)@{
11028 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11029
11030 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11031
11032 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11033 @}
11034 @end example
11035
11036 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11037 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11038 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11039 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11040 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11041 ``LookupCommand()''
11042
11043 @subsection The FOR command
11044
11045 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11046 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11047 command just like any other command.
11048
11049 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11050 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11051 are:
11052
11053 @enumerate 0
11054 @item The ascii text 'for'
11055 @item The start text
11056 @item The test expression
11057 @item The next text
11058 @item The body text
11059 @end enumerate
11060
11061 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11062 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11063 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11064 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11065
11066 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11067 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11068
11069 @example
11070 int
11071 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11072 int *argc,
11073 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11074 @end example
11075
11076 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11077 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11078 still operates in the same basic way.
11079
11080 @subsection FOR command implementation
11081
11082 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11083 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11084
11085 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11086
11087 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11088
11089 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11090 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11091 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11092
11093 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11094 expression and returns a value.
11095
11096 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11097 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11098 @example
11099 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11100
11101 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11102
11103 int
11104 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11105 int argc,
11106 char **argv )
11107 @{
11108 if( argc != 5 )@{
11109 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11110 return ERROR;
11111 @}
11112
11113 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11114
11115 // Execute the start statement.
11116 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11117
11118 // Top of loop test
11119 for(;;)@{
11120 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11121 if( i == 0 )
11122 break;
11123
11124 // Execute the body
11125 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11126
11127 // Execute the LOOP part
11128 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11129 @}
11130
11131 // Return no error
11132 SetResult( interp, "" );
11133 return SUCCESS;
11134 @}
11135 @end example
11136
11137 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11138 in the same basic way.
11139
11140 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11141
11142 @subsection source and find commands
11143 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11144 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11145 @*Remember the parsing rules
11146 @enumerate
11147 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11148 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11149 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11150 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11151 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11152 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11153 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11154 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11155 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11156 @end enumerate
11157 @subsection format command
11158 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11159 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11160 @b{sprintf()}.
11161 @b{Example}
11162 @example
11163 set x 6
11164 set y 7
11165 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11166 @end example
11167 @enumerate
11168 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11169 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11170 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11171 @* Refer to Rule #1
11172 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11173 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11174 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11175 @end enumerate
11176 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11177 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11178 @example
11179 #1 Good
11180 proc someproc @{@} @{
11181 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11182 @}
11183 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11184 #2 Good - no variables
11185 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11186 #3 Good Curly Braces
11187 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11188 puts "Time: [date]"
11189 @}
11190 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11191 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11192 @end example
11193 @enumerate
11194 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11195 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11196 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11197 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11198 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11199 command.
11200 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11201 @*There are 4 examples:
11202 @enumerate
11203 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11204 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11205 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11206 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11207 @end enumerate
11208
11209 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11210 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11211 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11212
11213 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11214 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11215 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11216 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11217 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11218 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11219 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11220 @end enumerate
11221 @subsection Global Variables
11222 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11223 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11224 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11225 @example
11226 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11227 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11228 global x #Global variable X
11229 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11230 @}
11231 @end example
11232 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11233 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11234 @example
11235 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11236 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11237 # Create var name
11238 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11239 # Make it a global
11240 global $vn
11241 # Set it.
11242 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11243 @}
11244 @end example
11245 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11246 @example
11247 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11248 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11249 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11250 @}
11251 @end example
11252
11253 @include fdl.texi
11254
11255 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11256 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11257 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11258 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11259 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11260 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11261
11262 @printindex cp
11263
11264 @node Command and Driver Index
11265 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11266 @printindex fn
11267
11268 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)